blob: 0a5fc80952bd62f548bf4f0cd89c28147849f3b6 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000039#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000040#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000041#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000042#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000043#include "llvm/Operator.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000044#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000045#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000046#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
47#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
48#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000049#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000050#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000051#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Torok Edwin7d696d82009-07-11 13:10:19 +000052#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000053#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000054#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000055#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000056#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000057#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000060#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000061#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000062#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000063#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000064#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000065#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000066using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000067using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000068
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
70STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
71STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
72STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
73STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000074
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000075namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000076 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
77 : public FunctionPass,
78 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000079 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000080 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000082 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000083 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000084 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000085 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000086 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000087
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000088 LLVMContext *getContext() { return Context; }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000089
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000090 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
91 /// isn't already in it.
92 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000093 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000094 Worklist.push_back(I);
95 }
96
97 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
98 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
99 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
100 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
101
102 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
103 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
104
105 WorklistMap.erase(It);
106 }
107
108 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
109 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
110 Worklist.pop_back();
111 WorklistMap.erase(I);
112 return I;
113 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000114
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000115
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000116 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
117 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
118 /// now.
119 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000120 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000121 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000122 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000123 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000124 }
125
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000126 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
127 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
128 ///
129 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000130 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
131 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000132 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000133 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000134
135 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
136 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
137 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
138 ///
139 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
140 ///
141 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
142 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
143
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000144 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
145 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000146 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000147 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000148 *i = Context->getUndef(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000149 }
150
151 return R;
152 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000153
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000154 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000155 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000156
157 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000158
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000159 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +0000160 AU.addRequired<TargetData>();
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000161 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000162 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000163 }
164
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000165 TargetData &getTargetData() const { return *TD; }
166
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
168 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
169 // Return Value:
170 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000171 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000172 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000173 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000174 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000175 Instruction *visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000176 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000177 Instruction *visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000178 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000179 Instruction *visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000180 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000183 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000184 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000186 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
190 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000191 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000192 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000193 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000194 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000195 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000196 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
197 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000198 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
199 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
200 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
201 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000202 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
203 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000204 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
205 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
206 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000207 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
208 Instruction *LHS,
209 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000210 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
211 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000212
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000213 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
214 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000215 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000216 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000217 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
218 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000219 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000220 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
221 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
222 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000223 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000224 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000225 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
226 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000227 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
228 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000229 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000230 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000231 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000232 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
233 Instruction *FI);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +0000234 Instruction *FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value*, Value*);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000235 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
236 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000237 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
238 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000239 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
240 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000241 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000242 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000243 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000244 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000245 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000246 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000247 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000248 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000249 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000250 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000251
252 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000253 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000254
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000255 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000256 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000257 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000258 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000259 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
260 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000261 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +0000262 DbgDeclareInst *hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V);
263
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000264
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000265 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000266 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
267 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
268 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000269 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000270 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
271 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000272 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
273 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000274 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000275 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000276 }
277
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000278 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
279 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
280 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000281 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
282 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000283 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000284
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000285 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000286 return Context->getConstantExprCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000287
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000288 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000289 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000290 return C;
291 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000292
293 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
294 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
295 }
296
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000297
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000298 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
299 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
300 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
301 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
302 // modified.
303 //
304 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000305 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000306 if (&I != V) {
307 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
308 return &I;
309 } else {
310 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
311 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000312 I.replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000313 return &I;
314 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000315 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000316
317 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
318 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
319 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
320 // this function.
321 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
322 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
323 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000324 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000325 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000326 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
327 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000328
329 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
330 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
331 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
332 }
333
334 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
335 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
336 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
337 }
338 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
339 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
340 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000341
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000342 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000343
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000344 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
345 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000346 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000347
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000348 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
349 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
350 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
351
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000352 /// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value
353 /// based on the demanded bits.
354 Value *SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
355 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
356 unsigned Depth);
357 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000358 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000359 unsigned Depth=0);
360
361 /// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
362 /// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
363 /// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
364 bool SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst);
365
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +0000366 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
367 APInt& UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000368
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000369 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
370 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
371 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
372 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
373
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000374 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
375 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
376 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
377 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000378 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
380
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000381
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000382 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
383 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000384
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000385 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000387 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000388 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000389 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000390 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000391 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000392 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000393 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000395
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000396 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000397
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000398 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +0000399 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000400 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
401 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000402
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000403 };
404}
405
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000406char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
407static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
408X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
409
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000410// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000411// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +0000412static unsigned getComplexity(LLVMContext *Context, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000413 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000414 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) ||
415 BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V) ||
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000416 BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000417 return 3;
418 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000419 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000420 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
421 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000422}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000423
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000424// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
425// it.
426static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000427 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000428}
429
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000430// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
431// though a va_arg area...
432static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000433 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
434 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
435 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000436 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000437 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000438}
439
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000440/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
441/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
442/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000443static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
Dan Gohman016de812009-07-17 23:55:56 +0000444 if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
445 if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
446 return O->getOperand(0);
447 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
448 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
449 return GEP->getPointerOperand();
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000450 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000451 return 0;
452}
453
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000454/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
455/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000456static Instruction::CastOps
457isEliminableCastPair(
458 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
459 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
460 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
461 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
462) {
463
464 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
465 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000466
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000467 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
468 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
469 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000470
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000471 unsigned Res = CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
472 DstTy, TD->getIntPtrType());
473
474 // We don't want to form an inttoptr or ptrtoint that converts to an integer
475 // type that differs from the pointer size.
476 if ((Res == Instruction::IntToPtr && SrcTy != TD->getIntPtrType()) ||
477 (Res == Instruction::PtrToInt && DstTy != TD->getIntPtrType()))
478 Res = 0;
479
480 return Instruction::CastOps(Res);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000481}
482
483/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
484/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
485/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000486static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
487 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000488 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
489
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000490 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000491 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000492 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000493 return false;
494 return true;
495}
496
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000497// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
498// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000499//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000500// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
501// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
502// binary operators.
503//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000504// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
505// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000506//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000507bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000508 bool Changed = false;
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +0000509 if (getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(0)) <
510 getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000511 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000512
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000513 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
514 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000515 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
516 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
517 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000518 Constant *Folded = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000519 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
520 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000521 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
522 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
523 return true;
524 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
525 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
526 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
527 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
528 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
529
530 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000531 Constant *Folded = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000532 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000533 Op1->getOperand(0),
534 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000535 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000536 I.setOperand(0, New);
537 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
538 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000539 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000540 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000541 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000542}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000543
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000544/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
545/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
546/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
547bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +0000548 if (getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(0)) >=
549 getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000550 return false;
551 I.swapOperands();
552 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
553 return true;
554}
555
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000556// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
557// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000558//
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000559static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000560 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000561 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000562
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000563 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
564 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000565 return Context->getConstantExprNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000566
567 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
568 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000569 return Context->getConstantExprNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000570
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000571 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000572}
573
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000574// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
575// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
576// form).
577//
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000578static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000579 if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000580 return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
581
582 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
583 if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000584 return Context->getConstantExprFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000585
586 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
587 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000588 return Context->getConstantExprFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000589
590 return 0;
591}
592
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000593static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000594 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000595 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000596
597 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000598 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000599 return Context->getConstantInt(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000600 return 0;
601}
602
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000603// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
604// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000605// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
606// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000607//
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000608static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000609 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000610 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000611 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000612 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000613 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000614 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000615 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000616 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000617 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000618 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000619 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000620 CST = Context->getConstantInt(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000621 return I->getOperand(0);
622 }
623 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000624 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000625}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000626
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000627/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
628/// expression, return it.
629static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
630 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
631 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
632 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
633 return cast<User>(V);
634 return false;
635}
636
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000637/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000638static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000639 return Context->getConstantExprAdd(C,
640 Context->getConstantInt(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000641}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000642/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000643static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000644 return Context->getConstantExprSub(C,
645 Context->getConstantInt(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000646}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000647/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
648/// this size.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000649static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000650 LLVMContext *Context) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000651 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
652 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
653 if (sign) {
654 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
655 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
656 } else {
657 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
658 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
659 }
660
661 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
662
663 if (sign) {
664 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
665 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
666 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
667 } else
668 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
669}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000670
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000671
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000672/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
673/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
674/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
675/// constant and return true.
676static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000677 APInt Demanded, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000678 assert(I && "No instruction?");
679 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
680
681 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
682 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
683 if (!OpC) return false;
684
685 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
686 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
687 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
688 return false;
689
690 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
691 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000692 I->setOperand(OpNo, Context->getConstantInt(Demanded));
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000693 return true;
694}
695
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000696// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
697// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
698// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
699// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000700static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000701 const APInt& KnownOne,
702 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000703 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
704 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
705 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
706 "KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000707 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000708
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000709 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
710 // bit if it is unknown.
711 Min = KnownOne;
712 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
713
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000714 if (UnknownBits.isNegative()) { // Sign bit is unknown
715 Min.set(Min.getBitWidth()-1);
716 Max.clear(Max.getBitWidth()-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000717 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000718}
719
720// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
721// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
722// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
723// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000724static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt &KnownZero,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000725 const APInt &KnownOne,
726 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000727 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
728 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
729 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000730 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000731 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000732
733 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
734 Min = KnownOne;
735 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
736 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
737}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000738
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000739/// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
740/// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
741/// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
742bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000743 unsigned BitWidth = Inst.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000744 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
745 APInt DemandedMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
746
747 Value *V = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(&Inst, DemandedMask,
748 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0);
749 if (V == 0) return false;
750 if (V == &Inst) return true;
751 ReplaceInstUsesWith(Inst, V);
752 return true;
753}
754
755/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This form of SimplifyDemandedBits simplifies the
756/// specified instruction operand if possible, updating it in place. It returns
757/// true if it made any change and false otherwise.
758bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
759 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
760 unsigned Depth) {
761 Value *NewVal = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(U.get(), DemandedMask,
762 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
763 if (NewVal == 0) return false;
764 U.set(NewVal);
765 return true;
766}
767
768
769/// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
770/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000771/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
772/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
773/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
774/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
775/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000776/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000777/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
778/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
779/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
780/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
781/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
782/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
783/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000784///
785/// This returns null if it did not change anything and it permits no
786/// simplification. This returns V itself if it did some simplification of V's
787/// operands based on the information about what bits are demanded. This returns
788/// some other non-null value if it found out that V is equal to another value
789/// in the context where the specified bits are demanded, but not for all users.
790Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
791 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
792 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000793 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
794 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
795 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000796 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
797 assert((TD || !isa<PointerType>(VTy)) &&
798 "SimplifyDemandedBits needs to know bit widths!");
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000799 assert((!TD || TD->getTypeSizeInBits(VTy->getScalarType()) == BitWidth) &&
800 (!VTy->isIntOrIntVector() ||
801 VTy->getScalarSizeInBits() == BitWidth) &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000802 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000803 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000804 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne "
805 "must have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
807 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
808 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
809 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000810 return 0;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000811 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000812 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V)) {
813 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
814 KnownOne.clear();
815 KnownZero = DemandedMask;
816 return 0;
817 }
818
Chris Lattner08d2cc72009-01-31 07:26:06 +0000819 KnownZero.clear();
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000820 KnownOne.clear();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000821 if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
822 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
823 return 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000824 return Context->getUndef(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000825 }
826
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000827 if (Depth == 6) // Limit search depth.
828 return 0;
829
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000830 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
831 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
832
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000833 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
834 if (!I) {
835 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
836 return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
837 }
838
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000839 // If there are multiple uses of this value and we aren't at the root, then
840 // we can't do any simplifications of the operands, because DemandedMask
841 // only reflects the bits demanded by *one* of the users.
842 if (Depth != 0 && !I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000843 // Despite the fact that we can't simplify this instruction in all User's
844 // context, we can at least compute the knownzero/knownone bits, and we can
845 // do simplifications that apply to *just* the one user if we know that
846 // this instruction has a simpler value in that context.
847 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
848 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
849 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
850 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
851 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
852 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
853
854 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
855 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and' in this
856 // context.
857 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
858 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
859 return I->getOperand(0);
860 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
861 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
862 return I->getOperand(1);
863
864 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
865 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000866 return Context->getNullValue(VTy);
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000867
868 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
869 // We can simplify (X|Y) -> X or Y in the user's context if we know that
870 // only bits from X or Y are demanded.
871
872 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
873 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
874 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
875 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
876 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
877
878 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the
879 // other. These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or' in this
880 // context.
881 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
882 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
883 return I->getOperand(0);
884 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
885 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
886 return I->getOperand(1);
887
888 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
889 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
890 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
891 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
892 return I->getOperand(0);
893 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
894 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
895 return I->getOperand(1);
896 }
897
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000898 // Compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
899 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
900 return 0;
901 }
902
903 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
904 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits so that we can try to simplify the
905 // operands. This allows visitTruncInst (for example) to simplify the
906 // operand of a trunc without duplicating all the logic below.
907 if (Depth == 0 && !V->hasOneUse())
908 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
909
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000910 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000911 default:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000912 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000913 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000914 case Instruction::And:
915 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000916 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
917 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
918 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000919 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000920 return I;
921 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
922 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000923
924 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
925 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
926 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
927 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000928 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000929 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
930 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000931 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000932
933 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
934 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000935 return Context->getNullValue(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000936
937 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000938 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000939 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000940
941 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
942 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
943 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
944 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
945 break;
946 case Instruction::Or:
947 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000948 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
949 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
950 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000951 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000952 return I;
953 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
954 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000955
956 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
957 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
958 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
959 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000960 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000961 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
962 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000963 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000964
965 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
966 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
967 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
968 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000969 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000970 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
971 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000972 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000973
974 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000975 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000976 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000977
978 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
979 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
980 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
981 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
982 break;
983 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000984 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
985 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
986 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000987 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000988 return I;
989 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
990 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000991
992 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
993 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
994 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000995 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000996 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000997 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000998
999 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1000 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1001 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1002 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1003 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1004 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1005
1006 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1007 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1008 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1009 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1010 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001011 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001012 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001013 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001014 }
1015
1016 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1017 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1018 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1019 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1020 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1021 // all known
1022 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001023 Constant *AndC = Context->getConstantInt(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001024 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001025 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001026 return InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001027 }
1028 }
1029
1030 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1031 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001032 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001033 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001034
1035 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1036 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1037 break;
1038 }
1039 case Instruction::Select:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001040 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(2), DemandedMask,
1041 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1042 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001043 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001044 return I;
1045 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1046 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001047
1048 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001049 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask, Context) ||
1050 ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001051 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001052
1053 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1054 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1055 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1056 break;
1057 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001058 unsigned truncBf = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001059 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1060 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1061 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001062 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001063 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001064 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001065 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1066 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1067 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001068 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001069 break;
1070 }
1071 case Instruction::BitCast:
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001072 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrIntVector())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001073 return false; // vector->int or fp->int?
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001074
1075 if (const VectorType *DstVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getType())) {
1076 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy =
1077 dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
1078 if (DstVTy->getNumElements() != SrcVTy->getNumElements())
1079 // Don't touch a bitcast between vectors of different element counts.
1080 return false;
1081 } else
1082 // Don't touch a scalar-to-vector bitcast.
1083 return false;
1084 } else if (isa<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType()))
1085 // Don't touch a vector-to-scalar bitcast.
1086 return false;
1087
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001088 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001089 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001090 return I;
1091 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001092 break;
1093 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1094 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001095 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001096
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001097 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1098 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1099 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001100 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001101 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001102 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001103 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1104 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1105 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001106 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001107 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001108 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001109 break;
1110 }
1111 case Instruction::SExt: {
1112 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001113 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001114
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001115 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001116 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001117
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001118 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001119 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1120 // bit is demanded.
1121 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001122 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001123
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001124 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1125 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1126 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001127 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InputDemandedBits,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001128 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001129 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001130 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1131 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1132 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001133 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001134
1135 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1136 // top bits of the result.
1137
1138 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1139 // convert this into a zero extension.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001140 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001141 // Convert to ZExt cast
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001142 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName());
1143 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *I);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001144 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001145 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001146 }
1147 break;
1148 }
1149 case Instruction::Add: {
1150 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1151 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1152 // either.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001153 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001154
1155 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1156 // we can do.
1157 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1158 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1159 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1160 if (RHS->isZero())
1161 break;
1162
1163 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1164 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001165 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001166
1167 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001168 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InDemandedBits,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001170 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001171
1172 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1173 // the constant.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001174 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001175 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001176
1177 // Avoid excess work.
1178 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1179 break;
1180
1181 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1182 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1183 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001184 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001185 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001186 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001187 }
1188
1189 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1190 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1191 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1192 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1193 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1194
1195 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1196 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1197 // this scan.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001198 const APInt &RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001199 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001200
1201 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1202
1203 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1204 // other, and there is no input carry.
1205 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1206 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1207
1208 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1209 // is no input carry.
1210 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1211 } else {
1212 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1213 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001214 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001215 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1216 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001217 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001218 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1219 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1220 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001221 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001222 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001223 }
1224 }
1225 break;
1226 }
1227 case Instruction::Sub:
1228 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1229 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001230 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001231 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1232 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001233 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001234 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001235 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1236 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1237 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001238 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001239 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001240 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001241 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1242 // the known zeros and ones.
1243 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001244 break;
1245 case Instruction::Shl:
1246 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001247 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001248 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001249 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001250 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001251 return I;
1252 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1254 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1255 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001256 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001257 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001258 }
1259 break;
1260 case Instruction::LShr:
1261 // For a logical shift right
1262 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001263 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001264
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001265 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001266 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001267 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001269 return I;
1270 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001271 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1272 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001273 if (ShiftAmt) {
1274 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001275 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001276 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1277 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001278 }
1279 break;
1280 case Instruction::AShr:
1281 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1282 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1283 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1284 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1285 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1286 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001287 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001288 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001289 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001290 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001291
1292 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1293 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1294 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001295 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001296
1297 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001298 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001299
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001300 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001301 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001302 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1303 // demanded.
1304 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1305 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001306 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001307 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001308 return I;
1309 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001310 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001311 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001312 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1313 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1314
1315 // Handle the sign bits.
1316 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1317 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1318 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1319
1320 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1321 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001322 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001323 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1324 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001325 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001326 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001327 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001328 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1329 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1330 }
1331 }
1332 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001333 case Instruction::SRem:
1334 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001335 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1336 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Eli Friedmana999a512009-06-17 02:57:36 +00001337 if (DemandedMask.ult(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001338 return I->getOperand(0);
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001339
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001340 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001341 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001342 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), Mask2,
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001343 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001344 return I;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001345
1346 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1347 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001348
1349 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001350
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001351 assert(!(KnownZero & KnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001352 }
1353 }
1354 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001355 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001356 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1357 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001358 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), AllOnes,
1359 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1) ||
1360 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001361 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001362 return I;
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001363
Chris Lattner455e9ab2009-01-21 18:09:24 +00001364 unsigned Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001365 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1366 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1367 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001368 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001369 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001370 case Instruction::Call:
1371 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1372 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1373 default: break;
1374 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1375 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1376 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1377 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1378 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1379
1380 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1381 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1382 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1383 NLZ &= ~7;
1384 NTZ &= ~7;
1385 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1386 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1387 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1388 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1389
1390 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1391 // the right place.
1392 Instruction *NewVal;
1393 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1394 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001395 Context->getConstantInt(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001396 else
1397 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001398 Context->getConstantInt(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001399 NewVal->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001400 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001401 }
1402
1403 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1404 break;
1405 }
1406 }
1407 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001408 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001409 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001410 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001411
1412 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1413 // constant.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00001414 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001415 Constant *C = Context->getConstantInt(RHSKnownOne);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00001416 if (isa<PointerType>(V->getType()))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001417 C = Context->getConstantExprIntToPtr(C, V->getType());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00001418 return C;
1419 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001420 return false;
1421}
1422
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001423
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001424/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001425/// any number of elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001426/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1427/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1428///
1429/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1430/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1431/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001432Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
1433 APInt& UndefElts,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001434 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001435 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001436 APInt EltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001437 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001438
1439 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1440 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1441 UndefElts = EltMask;
1442 return 0;
1443 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1444 UndefElts = EltMask;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001445 return Context->getUndef(V->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001446 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001447
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001448 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001449 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1450 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001451 Constant *Undef = Context->getUndef(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001452
1453 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1454 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001455 if (!DemandedElts[i]) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001456 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001457 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001458 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1459 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001460 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001461 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1462 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1463 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001464
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001465 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001466 Constant *NewCP = Context->getConstantVector(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001467 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1468 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001469 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001470 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001471
1472 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1473 // anything.
1474 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1475 return 0;
1476
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001477 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001478 Constant *Zero = Context->getNullValue(EltTy);
1479 Constant *Undef = Context->getUndef(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001480 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001481 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
1482 Constant *Elt = DemandedElts[i] ? Zero : Undef;
1483 Elts.push_back(Elt);
1484 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001485 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001486 return Context->getConstantVector(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001487 }
1488
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001489 // Limit search depth.
1490 if (Depth == 10)
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001491 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001492
1493 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1494 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1495 // are needed.
1496 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1497 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1498 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1499 // the main instcombine process.
1500 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001501 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001502 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001503
1504 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1505 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001506 }
1507
1508 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001509 if (!I) return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001510
1511 bool MadeChange = false;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001512 APInt UndefElts2(VWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001513 Value *TmpV;
1514 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1515 default: break;
1516
1517 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1518 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1519 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001520 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001521 if (Idx == 0) {
1522 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1523 // which elt is getting updated.
1524 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1525 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1526 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1527 break;
1528 }
1529
1530 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1531 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001532 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001533 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || !DemandedElts[IdxNo])
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001534 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1535
1536 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1537 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001538 APInt DemandedElts2 = DemandedElts;
1539 DemandedElts2.clear(IdxNo);
1540 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts2,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001541 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1542 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1543
1544 // The inserted element is defined.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001545 UndefElts.clear(IdxNo);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001546 break;
1547 }
1548 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1549 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001550 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1551 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001552 APInt LeftDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0), RightDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001553 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001554 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001555 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1556 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001557 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001558 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001559 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001560 LeftDemanded.set(MaskVal);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001561 else
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001562 RightDemanded.set(MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001563 }
1564 }
1565 }
1566
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001567 APInt UndefElts4(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001568 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001569 UndefElts4, Depth+1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001570 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1571
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001572 APInt UndefElts3(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001573 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1574 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1575 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1576
1577 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1578 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1579 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001580 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001581 UndefElts.set(i);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001582 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001583 if (UndefElts4[MaskVal]) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001584 NewUndefElts = true;
1585 UndefElts.set(i);
1586 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001587 } else {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001588 if (UndefElts3[MaskVal - LHSVWidth]) {
1589 NewUndefElts = true;
1590 UndefElts.set(i);
1591 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001592 }
1593 }
1594
1595 if (NewUndefElts) {
1596 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1597 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1598 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001599 if (UndefElts[i])
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001600 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001601 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001602 Elts.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty,
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001603 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1604 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001605 I->setOperand(2, Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001606 MadeChange = true;
1607 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001608 break;
1609 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001610 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001611 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001612 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1613 if (!VTy) break;
1614 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001615 APInt InputDemandedElts(InVWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001616 unsigned Ratio;
1617
1618 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001619 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001620 // elements as are demanded of us.
1621 Ratio = 1;
1622 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1623 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1624 // Untested so far.
1625 break;
1626
1627 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1628 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1629 // elements are live.
1630 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1631 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001632 if (DemandedElts[OutIdx])
1633 InputDemandedElts.set(OutIdx/Ratio);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001634 }
1635 } else {
1636 // Untested so far.
1637 break;
1638
1639 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1640 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1641 // live.
1642 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1643 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001644 if (DemandedElts[InIdx/Ratio])
1645 InputDemandedElts.set(InIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001646 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001647
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001648 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1649 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1650 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1651 if (TmpV) {
1652 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1653 MadeChange = true;
1654 }
1655
1656 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1657 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001658 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001659 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1660 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1661 // undef.
1662 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001663 if (UndefElts2[OutIdx/Ratio])
1664 UndefElts.set(OutIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001665 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001666 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001667 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1668 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1669 // elements are undef.
1670 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1671 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001672 if (!UndefElts2[InIdx]) // Not undef?
1673 UndefElts.clear(InIdx/Ratio); // Clear undef bit.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001674 }
1675 break;
1676 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001677 case Instruction::And:
1678 case Instruction::Or:
1679 case Instruction::Xor:
1680 case Instruction::Add:
1681 case Instruction::Sub:
1682 case Instruction::Mul:
1683 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1684 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1685 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1686 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1687 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1688 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1689 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1690
1691 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1692 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1693 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1694 break;
1695
1696 case Instruction::Call: {
1697 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1698 if (!II) break;
1699 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1700 default: break;
1701
1702 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1703 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1704 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1705 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1706 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1707 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1708 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1709 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1710 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1711 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1712 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1713 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1714 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1715 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1716 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1717 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1718
1719 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1720 // scalarize it now.
1721 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1722 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1723 default: break;
1724 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1725 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1726 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1727 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1728 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1729 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1730 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1731 // Extract the element as scalars.
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00001732 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS,
1733 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
1734 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS,
1735 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001736
1737 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001738 default: llvm_unreachable("Case stmts out of sync!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001739 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1740 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001741 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001742 II->getName()), *II);
1743 break;
1744 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1745 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001746 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001747 II->getName()), *II);
1748 break;
1749 }
1750
1751 Instruction *New =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001752 InsertElementInst::Create(
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00001753 Context->getUndef(II->getType()), TmpV,
1754 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0U, false), II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001755 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1756 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1757 return New;
1758 }
1759 }
1760
1761 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1762 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1763 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1764 break;
1765 }
1766 break;
1767 }
1768 }
1769 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1770}
1771
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001772
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001773/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1774/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1775/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1776/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1777/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1778/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1779/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1780///
1781template<typename Functor>
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001782static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001783 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001784 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1785 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1786
1787 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1788 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1789 return F.apply(Root);
1790
1791 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1792 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001793 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001794 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1795 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1796
1797 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1798 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1799 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1800 ShouldApply = true;
1801 }
1802
1803 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1804 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1805 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001806 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1807 // and perform the reassociation.
1808 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1809
1810 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1811 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1812
1813 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1814 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001815 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001816 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001817 return 0;
1818 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001819 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001820 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001821 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001822 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001823 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001824
1825 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1826 // get to LHSI.
1827 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1828 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001829 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1830 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001831 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001832 ARI = NextLHSI;
1833
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001834 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1835 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1836 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1837 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1838 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001839
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001840 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1841 // the transformation...
1842 return F.apply(Root);
1843 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001844
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001845 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1846 }
1847 return 0;
1848}
1849
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001850namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001851
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001852// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001853struct AddRHS {
1854 Value *RHS;
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001855 LLVMContext *Context;
1856 AddRHS(Value *rhs, LLVMContext *C) : RHS(rhs), Context(C) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001857 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1858 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001859 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001860 Context->getConstantInt(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001861 }
1862};
1863
1864// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1865// iff C1&C2 == 0
1866struct AddMaskingAnd {
1867 Constant *C2;
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001868 LLVMContext *Context;
1869 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c, LLVMContext *C) : C2(c), Context(C) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001870 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001871 ConstantInt *C1;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00001872 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001873 Context->getConstantExprAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001874 }
1875 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001876 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001877 }
1878};
1879
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001880}
1881
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001882static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001883 InstCombiner *IC) {
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001884 LLVMContext *Context = IC->getContext();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001885
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001886 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00001887 return IC->InsertCastBefore(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001888 }
1889
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001890 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001891 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1892 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001893
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001894 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1895 if (ConstIsRHS)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001896 return Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1897 return Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001898 }
1899
1900 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1901 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1902 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1903 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001904 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001905 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001906 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00001907 New = CmpInst::Create(*Context, CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(),
1908 Op0, Op1, SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001909 else {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001910 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001911 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001912 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1913}
1914
1915// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1916// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1917// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1918// not have a second operand.
1919static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1920 InstCombiner *IC) {
1921 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1922 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1923 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1924 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1925
1926 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001927 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001928 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001929
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001930 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1931 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1932
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001933 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1934 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001935 }
1936 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001937}
1938
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001939
1940/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1941/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1942/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1943Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1944 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001945 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001946 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001947
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001948 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1949 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001950 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001951 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1952 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1953 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1954 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001955 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001956 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1957
1958 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1959 // loop.
1960 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1961 return 0;
1962 }
1963
1964 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1965 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1966 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1967 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1968 if (NonConstBB) {
1969 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1970 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1971 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001972
1973 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001974 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001975 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001976 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001977 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001978
1979 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1980 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1981 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001982 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001983 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001984 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001985 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001986 InV = Context->getConstantExprCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001987 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001988 InV = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001989 } else {
1990 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1991 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001992 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001993 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1994 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001995 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00001996 InV = CmpInst::Create(*Context, CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001997 CI->getPredicate(),
1998 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1999 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002000 else
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00002001 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002002
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00002003 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002004 }
2005 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002006 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002007 } else {
2008 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
2009 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002010 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002011 Value *InV;
2012 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002013 InV = Context->getConstantExprCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002014 } else {
2015 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002016 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002017 I.getType(), "phitmp",
2018 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00002019 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002020 }
2021 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002022 }
2023 }
2024 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
2025}
2026
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002027
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002028/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
2029/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
2030/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
2031/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
2032bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2033 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
2034 // ones.
2035
2036 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
2037 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
2038 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
2039 // sign extend fine.
2040 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
2041 return true;
2042
2043
2044 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
2045 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
2046 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
2047 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
2048
2049 // TODO: Implement.
2050
2051 return false;
2052}
2053
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002054
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002055Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002056 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002057 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002058
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002059 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002060 // X + undef -> undef
2061 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
2062 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
2063
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002064 // X + 0 --> X
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002065 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2066 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002067
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002068 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002069 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002070 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002071 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002072 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002073 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002074
2075 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2076 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002077 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00002078 return &I;
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002079
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002080 // zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002081 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002082 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::Int1Ty)
2083 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI, Context), CI);
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002084 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002085
2086 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2087 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2088 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002089
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002090 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2091 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002092 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002093 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)), *Context)) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002094 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002095 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002096
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002097 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002098 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2099 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002100 do {
2101 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002102 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2103 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002104 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2105 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002106 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002107 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2108 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002109 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002110 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002111 }
2112 }
2113 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002114 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2115 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2116 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002117
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002118 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002119 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2120 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2121 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002122 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2123 switch (Size) {
2124 default: break;
2125 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2126 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2127 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2128 }
2129 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002130 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002131 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002132 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002133 }
2134 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002135 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002136
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002137 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2138 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2139
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002140 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002141 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002142 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS, Context), Context))
2143 return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002144
2145 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2146 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2147 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2148 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2149 }
2150 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2151 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2152 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2153 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2154 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002155 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002156
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002157 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002158 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002159 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS, Context)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002160 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002161 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS, Context)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002162 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002163 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002164 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002165 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002166 }
2167
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002168 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002169 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002170
2171 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002172 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002173 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS, Context))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002174 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002175
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002176
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002177 ConstantInt *C2;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002178 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2, Context)) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002179 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002180 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2, Context));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002181
2182 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2183 ConstantInt *C1;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002184 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1, Context))
2185 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Context->getConstantExprAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002186 }
2187
2188 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002189 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2, Context) == LHS)
2190 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2, Context));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002191
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002192 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002193 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS, Context) == RHS ||
2194 dyn_castNotVal(RHS, Context) == LHS)
2195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002196
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002197
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002198 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002199 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2)), *Context))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002200 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2, Context), Context))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002201 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002202
2203 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2204 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2205 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2206 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2207 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2208 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2209 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2210 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2211 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2212 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2213
2214 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002215 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002216 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002217 }
2218 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002219
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002220 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002221 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002222 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002223 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X)), *Context) &&
2224 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)), *Context)) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002225 if (W != Y) {
2226 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002227 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002228 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002229 std::swap(W, X);
2230 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002231 std::swap(Y, Z);
2232 std::swap(W, X);
2233 }
2234 }
2235
2236 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002237 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002238 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002239 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002240 }
2241 }
2242 }
2243
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002244 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002245 Value *X = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002246 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)), *Context)) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002247 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS, Context), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002248
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002249 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002250 if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
2251 match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)), *Context)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002252 Constant *Anded = Context->getConstantExprAnd(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002253 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2254 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2255 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002256 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002257
2258 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002259 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002260
2261 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002262 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002263
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002264 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2265 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002266 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002267 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002268 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002269 }
2270 }
2271 }
2272
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002273 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2274 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002275 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002276 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002277 }
2278
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002279 // add (cast *A to intptrtype) B ->
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00002280 // cast (GEP (cast *A to i8*) B) --> intptrtype
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002281 {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002282 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(LHS);
2283 Value *Other = RHS;
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002284 if (!CI) {
2285 CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(RHS);
2286 Other = LHS;
2287 }
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002288 if (CI && CI->getType()->isSized() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002289 (CI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() ==
Reid Spencerabaa8ca2007-01-08 16:32:00 +00002290 TD->getIntPtrType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits())
Andrew Lenharth45633262006-09-20 15:37:57 +00002291 && isa<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +00002292 unsigned AS =
2293 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00002294 Value *I2 = InsertBitCastBefore(CI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002295 Context->getPointerType(Type::Int8Ty, AS), I);
Dan Gohman3a7a68c2009-07-17 22:25:10 +00002296 GetElementPtrInst *GEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(I2, Other, "ctg2");
2297 // A GEP formed from an arbitrary add may overflow.
2298 cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->setHasNoPointerOverflow(false);
2299 I2 = InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002300 return new PtrToIntInst(I2, CI->getType());
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002301 }
2302 }
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002303
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002304 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002305 {
2306 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002307 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002308 if (!SI) {
2309 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002310 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002311 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002312 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002313 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2314 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002315 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002316
2317 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2318 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002319 if (match(FV, m_Zero(), *Context) &&
2320 match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A)), *Context))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002321 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002322 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002323 if (match(TV, m_Zero(), *Context) &&
2324 match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A)), *Context))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002325 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002326 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002327 }
2328 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002329
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002330 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2331 // integer add followed by a sext.
2332 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2333 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2334 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2335 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002336 Context->getConstantExprTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002337 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002338 Context->getConstantExprSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002339 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2340 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2341 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2342 CI, "addconv");
2343 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2344 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2345 }
2346 }
2347
2348 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2349 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2350 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2351 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2352 // integer add will not overflow.
2353 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2354 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2355 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2356 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2357 // Insert the new integer add.
2358 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2359 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2360 "addconv");
2361 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2362 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2363 }
2364 }
2365 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002366
2367 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2368}
2369
2370Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
2371 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2372 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
2373
2374 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
2375 // X + 0 --> X
2376 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002377 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(Context->getConstantFPNegativeZero
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002378 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
2379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2380 }
2381
2382 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2383 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2384 return NV;
2385 }
2386
2387 // -A + B --> B - A
2388 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002389 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS, Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002390 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
2391
2392 // A + -B --> A - B
2393 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002394 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS, Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002395 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
2396
2397 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2398 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2399 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2400 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2401
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002402 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2403 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2404 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2405 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2406 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2407 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2408 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2409 // instcombined.
2410 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2411 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002412 Context->getConstantExprFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002413 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002414 Context->getConstantExprSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002415 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2416 // Insert the new integer add.
2417 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2418 CI, "addconv");
2419 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2420 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2421 }
2422 }
2423
2424 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2425 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2426 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2427 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2428 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2429 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2430 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2431 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2432 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2433 // Insert the new integer add.
2434 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2435 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2436 "addconv");
2437 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2438 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2439 }
2440 }
2441 }
2442
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002443 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002444}
2445
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002446Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002447 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002448
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002449 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002450 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002451
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002452 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002453 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1, Context))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002454 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002455
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002456 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2457 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2458 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2459 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2460
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002461 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2462 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002463 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00002464 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002465
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002466 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002467 Value *X = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002468 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X)), *Context))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002469 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C, Context));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002470
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002471 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2472 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002473 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002474 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002475 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002476 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002477 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002478 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002479 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002480 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002481 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002482 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002483 }
2484 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002485 }
2486 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2487 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2488 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002489 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002490 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002491 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002492 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002493 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002494 }
2495 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002496 }
2497 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002498 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002499
2500 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2501 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002502 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002503 return R;
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002504
2505 // C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
2506 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
2507 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::Int1Ty)
2508 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C, Context), C);
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002509 }
2510
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002511 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2512 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2513
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002514 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002515 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002516 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002517 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(1),
2518 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002519 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002520 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(0),
2521 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002522 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2523 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2524 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002525 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
2526 Context->getConstantExprSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002527 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002528 }
2529
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002530 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002531 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2532 // is not used by anyone else...
2533 //
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002534 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002535 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2536 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2537 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2538 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002539
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002540 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002541 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002542 }
2543
2544 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2545 //
2546 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2547 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2548 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2549
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002550 Value *NewNot =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00002551 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
2552 OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002553 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002554 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002555
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002556 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002557 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002558 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002559 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002560 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002561 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002562 Context->getConstantExprNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002563
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002564 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002565 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002566 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2, Context) == Op0) {
2567 Constant *CP1 =
2568 Context->getConstantExprSub(Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002569 C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002570 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002571 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002572 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002573 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002574
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002575 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2576 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2577 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2578 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2579 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2580 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2581 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2582 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002583 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0I->getOperand(1),
2584 I.getName());
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002585 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002586 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002587
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002588 ConstantInt *C1;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002589 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1, Context)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002590 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002591 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1, Context));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002592
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002593 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002594 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2, Context))
2595 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Context->getConstantExprSub(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002596 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002597 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002598}
2599
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002600Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
2601 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2602
2603 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002604 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1, Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002605 return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
2606
2607 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2608 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
2609 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002610 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(1),
2611 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002612 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002613 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(0),
2614 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002615 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002616 }
2617
2618 return 0;
2619}
2620
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002621/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2622/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2623/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2624/// signed.
2625static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2626 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002627 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2629 TrueIfSigned = true;
2630 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002631 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2632 TrueIfSigned = true;
2633 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002634 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2635 TrueIfSigned = false;
2636 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002637 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2638 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2639 TrueIfSigned = true;
2640 return RHS->getValue() ==
2641 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2642 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2643 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2644 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002645 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002646 default:
2647 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002648 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002649}
2650
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002651Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002652 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002653 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002654
Dan Gohman77b81fe2009-06-04 17:12:12 +00002655 // TODO: If Op1 is undef and Op0 is finite, return zero.
2656 if (!I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector() &&
2657 isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002659
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002660 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002661 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2662 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002663
2664 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002665 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002666 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2667 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002668 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002669 Context->getConstantExprShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002670
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002671 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002672 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2673 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2675 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002676 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002677
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002678 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002679 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002680 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002681 Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002682 }
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002683 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
Eli Friedmanb4687092009-07-14 02:01:53 +00002684 if (Op1->isNullValue())
2685 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002686
2687 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2688 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002689 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0, I.getName());
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002690
2691 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2692 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002693 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
2694 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
2695 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2696 }
2697 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002698 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002699
2700 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2701 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002702 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002703 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002704 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002705 Op1, "tmp");
2706 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002707 Value *C1C2 = Context->getConstantExprMul(Op1,
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002708 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002709 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002710
2711 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002712
2713 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2714 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002715 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002716 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002717
2718 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2719 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2720 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002721 }
2722
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002723 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0, Context)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2724 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1), Context))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002725 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002726
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002727 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
2728 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
2729 {
2730 Value *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2731 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
2732 if (!BO ||
2733 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
2734 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
2735 Op1 = Op0;
2736 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1));
2737 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002738 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1, Context);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002739 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
2740 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1 || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
2741 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
2742 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
2743 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
2744
2745 Instruction *Rem;
2746 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
2747 Rem = BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
2748 else
2749 Rem = BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
2750
2751 InsertNewInstBefore(Rem, I);
2752 Rem->takeName(BO);
2753
2754 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2755 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
2756 else
2757 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
2758 }
2759 }
2760
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002761 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2762 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2763
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002764 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2765 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2766 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2767 // formed.
2768 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002769 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002770 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002771 BoolCast = CI;
2772 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002773 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002774 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002775 BoolCast = CI;
2776 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002777 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002778 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2779 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002780 bool TIS = false;
2781
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002782 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002783 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2784 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002785 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2786 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002787 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002788 Constant *Amt = Context->getConstantInt(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002789 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002790 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002791 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002792 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002793 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2794 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002795
2796 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2797 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002798 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002799 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2800 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002801 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2802 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2803 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2804 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2805 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002806
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002807 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002808 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002809 }
2810 }
2811 }
2812
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002813 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002814}
2815
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002816Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
2817 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2818 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
2819
2820 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
2821 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2822 if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
2823 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2824 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2825 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2826 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2827 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2828 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2829 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2830 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
2831 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
2832 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2833 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2834 }
2835 }
2836 }
2837
2838 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2839 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2840 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2841 return R;
2842
2843 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2844 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2845 return NV;
2846 }
2847
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002848 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0, Context)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2849 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(I.getOperand(1), Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002850 return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
2851
2852 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2853}
2854
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002855/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2856/// instruction.
2857bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2858 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2859
2860 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2861 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2862 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2863 if (ST->isNullValue())
2864 NonNullOperand = 2;
2865 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2866 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2867 if (ST->isNullValue())
2868 NonNullOperand = 1;
2869
2870 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2871 return false;
2872
2873 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2874
2875 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2876 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2877
2878 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2879 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2880 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2881 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2882 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2883
2884 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2885 // early exit.
2886 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2887 return true;
2888
2889 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2890 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2891
2892 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2893 --BBI;
2894 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2895 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2896 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2897 break;
2898
2899 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2900 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2901 I != E; ++I) {
2902 if (*I == SI) {
2903 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2904 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2905 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002906 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? Context->getConstantIntTrue() :
2907 Context->getConstantIntFalse();
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002908 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2909 }
2910 }
2911
2912 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2913 if (&*BBI == SI)
2914 SI = 0;
2915 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2916 SelectCond = 0;
2917
2918 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2919 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2920 break;
2921
2922 }
2923 return true;
2924}
2925
2926
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002927/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2928/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2929/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2930/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002931Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002932 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002933
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002934 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2935 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2936 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2937 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002939 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002940 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002941
2942 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002943 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002944 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002945
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002946 return 0;
2947}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002948
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002949/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2950/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2951/// division instructions.
2952/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002953Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002954 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2955
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002956 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002957 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2958 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002959 Constant *CI = Context->getConstantInt(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002960 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002961 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002962 }
2963
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002964 Constant *CI = Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002965 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2966 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002967
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002968 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2969 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002970
2971 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2972 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2973 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2974 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002975
2976 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2977 // div X, 1 == X
2978 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2979 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2980
2981 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2982 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2983 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2984 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002985 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
2986 I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv, Context))
2987 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002988 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002989 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002990 Context->getConstantExprMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002991 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002992
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002993 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002994 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2995 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2996 return R;
2997 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2998 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2999 return NV;
3000 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003001 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003002
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003003 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003004 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003005 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003006 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003007
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00003008 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
3009 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
3010 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3011
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00003012 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3013 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
3014 // div X, 1 == X
3015 if (X->isOne())
3016 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
3017 }
3018
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003019 return 0;
3020}
3021
3022Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3023 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3024
3025 // Handle the integer div common cases
3026 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3027 return Common;
3028
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003029 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003030 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
3031 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
3032 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003033 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003034 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003035 Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003036
3037 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
3038 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003039 Value *IC = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context,
3040 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, C),
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003041 I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003042 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()),
3043 Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003044 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003045 }
3046
3047 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003048 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003049 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3050 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003051 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003052 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003053 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003054 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00003055 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003056 Constant *C2V = Context->getConstantInt(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003057 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003058 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003059 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003060 }
3061 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00003062 }
3063
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003064 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
3065 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003066 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003067 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003068 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003069 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003070 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003071 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003072 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003073 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003074 Constant *TC = Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003075 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003076 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
3077 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
3078
3079 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003080 Constant *FC = Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003081 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003082 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
3083 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003084
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003085 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003086 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003087 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003088 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003089 return 0;
3090}
3091
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003092Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3093 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3094
3095 // Handle the integer div common cases
3096 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3097 return Common;
3098
3099 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3100 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
3101 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00003102 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003103 }
3104
3105 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
3106 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003107 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003108 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003109 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003110 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003111 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003112 }
3113 }
3114
3115 return 0;
3116}
3117
3118Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3119 return commonDivTransforms(I);
3120}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003121
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003122/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
3123/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
3124/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
3125/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
3126Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003127 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003128
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003129 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
3130 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3131 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003132 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003133 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003134 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3135 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003136
3137 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003138 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3139 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00003140
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003141 return 0;
3142}
3143
3144/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
3145/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3146/// remainder instructions.
3147/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
3148Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
3149 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3150
3151 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
3152 return common;
3153
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003154 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
3155 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
3156 if (LHS->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003157 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003158
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003159 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003160 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
3161 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003162 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getUndef(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003163
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003164 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003166
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003167 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
3168 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
3169 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3170 return R;
3171 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3172 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3173 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003174 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003175
3176 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00003177 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003178 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003179 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003180 }
3181
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003182 return 0;
3183}
3184
3185Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3186 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3187
3188 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3189 return common;
3190
3191 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3192 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3193 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3194 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3195 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003196 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003197 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C, Context));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003198 }
3199
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003200 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003201 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3202 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3203 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003204 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00003205 Constant *N1 = Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003206 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003207 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003208 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003209 }
3210 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003211 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003212
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003213 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3214 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3215 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3216 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3217 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3218 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003219 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3220 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003221 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003222 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO, Context),
3223 SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003224 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003225 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO, Context),
3226 SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003227 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003228 }
3229 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003230 }
3231
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003232 return 0;
3233}
3234
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003235Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3236 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3237
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003238 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003239 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3240 return common;
3241
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003242 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1, Context))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003243 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3244 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3245 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003246 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3247 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3248 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3249 return &I;
3250 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003251
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003252 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003253 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003254 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3255 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3256 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3257 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003258 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003259 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003260 }
3261
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003262 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003263 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3264 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003265
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003266 bool hasNegative = false;
3267 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3268 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3269 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3270 hasNegative = true;
3271
3272 if (hasNegative) {
3273 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003274 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3275 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3276 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003277 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(RHS));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003278 else
3279 Elts[i] = RHS;
3280 }
3281 }
3282
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003283 Constant *NewRHSV = Context->getConstantVector(Elts);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003284 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Nick Lewycky19c28922008-12-18 06:42:28 +00003285 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003286 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3287 return &I;
3288 }
3289 }
3290 }
3291
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003292 return 0;
3293}
3294
3295Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003296 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3297}
3298
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003299// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3300// constant.
3301static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003302 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003303}
3304
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003305// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3306// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3307static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003308 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003309}
3310
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003311/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003312/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3313///
3314/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3315///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003316/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3317/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003318///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003319/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3320/// 0 A > B
3321/// 1 A == B
3322/// 2 A < B
3323///
3324/// <=> Value Definition
3325/// 000 0 Always false
3326/// 001 1 A > B
3327/// 010 2 A == B
3328/// 011 3 A >= B
3329/// 100 4 A < B
3330/// 101 5 A != B
3331/// 110 6 A <= B
3332/// 111 7 Always true
3333///
3334static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3335 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003336 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003337 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3338 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3339 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3340 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3341 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3342 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3343 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3344 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3345 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3346 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003347 // True -> 7
3348 default:
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003349 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003350 return 0;
3351 }
3352}
3353
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003354/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3355/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3356/// predicate by reference.
3357static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3358 isOrdered = false;
3359 switch (CC) {
3360 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3361 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003362 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3363 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3364 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3365 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003366 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3367 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3368 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3369 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003370 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3371 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003372 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3373 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003374 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003375 default:
3376 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003377 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003378 return 0;
3379 }
3380}
3381
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003382/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3383/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003384/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003385/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003386static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003387 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003388 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003389 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003390 case 0: return Context->getConstantIntFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003391 case 1:
3392 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003393 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003394 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003395 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3396 case 2: return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003397 case 3:
3398 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003399 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003400 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003401 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003402 case 4:
3403 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003404 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003405 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003406 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3407 case 5: return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003408 case 6:
3409 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003410 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003411 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003412 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003413 case 7: return Context->getConstantIntTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003414 }
3415}
3416
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003417/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3418/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3419/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3420static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003421 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003422 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003423 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003424 case 0:
3425 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003426 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003427 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003428 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003429 case 1:
3430 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003431 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003432 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003433 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003434 case 2:
3435 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003436 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003437 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003438 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003439 case 3:
3440 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003441 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003442 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003443 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003444 case 4:
3445 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003446 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003447 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003448 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003449 case 5:
3450 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003451 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003452 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003453 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003454 case 6:
3455 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003456 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003457 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003458 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003459 case 7: return Context->getConstantIntTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003460 }
3461}
3462
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003463/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3464/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003465static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3466 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003467 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3468 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003469}
3470
3471namespace {
3472// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3473struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003474 InstCombiner &IC;
3475 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003476 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3477 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3478 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3479 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003480 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003481 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3482 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003483 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3484 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003485 return false;
3486 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003487 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3488 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3489 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3490 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3491 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003492 }
3493
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003494 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003495 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003496 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003497 unsigned Code;
3498 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3499 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3500 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3501 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003502 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003503 }
3504
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003505 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3506 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3507
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003508 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS, IC.getContext());
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003509 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3510 return I;
3511 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3512 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3513 }
3514};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003515} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003516
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003517// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3518// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003519// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003520Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003521 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3522 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003523 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3524 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003525 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003526 if (!Op->isShift())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003527 Together = Context->getConstantExprAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003528
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003529 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3530 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003531 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003532 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003533 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003534 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003535 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003536 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003537 }
3538 break;
3539 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003540 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3541 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003542
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003543 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3544 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003545 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003546 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003547 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003548 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003549 }
3550 break;
3551 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003552 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003553 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3554 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3555 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003556 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003557
3558 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003559 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003560 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3561 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3562 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003563 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003564
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003565 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3566 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3567 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3568 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3569 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3570 // no effect.
3571 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3572 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3573 return &TheAnd;
3574 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003575 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003576 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003577 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003578 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003579 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003580 }
3581 }
3582 }
3583 }
3584 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003585
3586 case Instruction::Shl: {
3587 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3588 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3589 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003590 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003591 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003592 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003593 ConstantInt *CI = Context->getConstantInt(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003594
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003595 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3596 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003597 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3598 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003599 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3600 return &TheAnd;
3601 }
3602 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003603 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003604 case Instruction::LShr:
3605 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003606 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3607 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3608 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3609 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003610 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003611 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003612 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003613 ConstantInt *CI = Context->getConstantInt(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003614
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003615 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3616 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003617 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3618 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3619 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3620 return &TheAnd;
3621 }
3622 break;
3623 }
3624 case Instruction::AShr:
3625 // Signed shr.
3626 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3627 // with an and.
3628 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003629 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003630 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003631 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003632 Constant *C = Context->getConstantInt(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003633 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003634 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003635 // Make the argument unsigned.
3636 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003637 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003638 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003639 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003640 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003641 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003642 }
3643 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003644 }
3645 return 0;
3646}
3647
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003648
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003649/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3650/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003651/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3652/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003653/// insert new instructions.
3654Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003655 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3656 Instruction &IB) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003657 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003658 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003659 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003660
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003661 if (Inside) {
3662 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003663 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003664
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003665 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003666 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003667 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003668 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003669 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003670 }
3671
3672 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003673 Constant *NegLo = Context->getConstantExprNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003674 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003675 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003676 Constant *UpperBound = Context->getConstantExprAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003677 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003678 }
3679
3680 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003681 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003682
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003683 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003684 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi), Context);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003685 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003686 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3687 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003688 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003689 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003690
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003691 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3692 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003693 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003694 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003695 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003696 Constant *LowerBound = Context->getConstantExprAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003697 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003698}
3699
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003700// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3701// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3702// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3703// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003704static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003705 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003706 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3707 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003708
3709 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003710 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003711 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003712 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003713 return true;
3714}
3715
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003716/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3717/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3718/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003719///
3720/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3721/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3722/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3723///
3724/// return (A +/- B).
3725///
3726Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003727 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003728 Instruction &I) {
3729 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3730 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3731 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3732
3733 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3734
3735 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3736 default: return 0;
3737 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003738 if (Context->getConstantExprAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003739 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003740 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3741 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3742 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003743 break;
3744
3745 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3746 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3747 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003748 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003749 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003750 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003751 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003752 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003753 break;
3754 }
3755 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003756 return 0;
3757 case Instruction::Or:
3758 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003759 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003760 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3761 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003762 && Context->getConstantExprAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003763 break;
3764 return 0;
3765 }
3766
3767 Instruction *New;
3768 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003769 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003770 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003771 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003772 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3773}
3774
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003775/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3776Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3777 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003778 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003779 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3780 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3781
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003782 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003783 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
3784 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst)), *Context) ||
3785 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
3786 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst)), *Context))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003787 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003788
3789 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3790 // where C is a power of 2
3791 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3792 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3793 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Val, Val2);
3794 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003795 return new ICmpInst(*Context, LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003796 }
3797
3798 // From here on, we only handle:
3799 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3800 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3801
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003802 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3803 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3804 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3805 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3806 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3807 return 0;
3808
3809 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3810 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3811 return 0;
3812
3813 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003814 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003815 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3816 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3817 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003818 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003819 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003820 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3821
3822 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003823 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3824 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3825 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3826 }
3827
3828 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3829 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3830 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3831 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3832 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3833 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3834 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3835
3836 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003837 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003838 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3839 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003840 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003841 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3842 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3843 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003845 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3847 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3849 }
3850 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3851 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003852 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003853 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003854 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003855 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003856 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3857 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003858 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003859 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003860 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3861 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3862 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3863 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3865 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003866 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3867 Constant *AddCST = Context->getConstantExprNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003868 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
3869 Val->getName()+".off");
3870 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003871 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003872 Context->getConstantInt(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003873 }
3874 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3875 }
3876 break;
3877 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3878 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003879 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003880 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3881 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3884 break;
3885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3886 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3887 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3889 break;
3890 }
3891 break;
3892 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3893 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003894 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003895 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3896 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003897 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3899 break;
3900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3901 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3902 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3903 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3904 break;
3905 }
3906 break;
3907 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3908 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003909 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003910 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3911 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3912 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3913 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3914 break;
3915 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003916 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst, Context)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003917 return new ICmpInst(*Context, LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003918 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003919 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003920 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst, Context),
3921 RHSCst, false, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003922 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3923 break;
3924 }
3925 break;
3926 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3927 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003928 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003929 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3930 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3931 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3932 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3933 break;
3934 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003935 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst, Context)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003936 return new ICmpInst(*Context, LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003937 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003938 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003939 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst, Context),
3940 RHSCst, true, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003941 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3942 break;
3943 }
3944 break;
3945 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003946
3947 return 0;
3948}
3949
3950
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003951Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00003952 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00003953 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003954
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003955 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003956 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00003957
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003958 // and X, X = X
3959 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00003960 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003961
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00003962 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00003963 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00003964 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
3965 return &I;
3966 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00003967 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003968 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003969 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00003970 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
3971 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00003972 }
3973 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00003974
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003975 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003976 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
3977 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003978
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003979 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003980 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003981 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003982 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
3983 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
3984 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
3985 case Instruction::Xor:
3986 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003987 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
3988 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
3989 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3990 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003991 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003992 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
3993 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003994 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003995 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003996 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003997 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00003998 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
3999 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004000 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004001 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
4002 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004003 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004004 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
4005 }
4006 }
4007
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004008 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004009 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004010 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4011 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4012 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4013 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004014 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004015 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004016 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004017 break;
4018
4019 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004020 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4021 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4022 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4023 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004024 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004025
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004026 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
4027 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
4028 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4029 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
4030 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
4031 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
4032
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004033 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004034 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
4035 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00004036 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0RHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004037 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
4038 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
4039 }
4040 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004041 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004042
4043 case Instruction::Shl:
4044 case Instruction::LShr:
4045 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
4046 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00004047 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004048 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
4049 Op0RHS, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004050 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
4051 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
4052 }
4053 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004054 }
4055
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00004056 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004057 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004058 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004059 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004060 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
4061 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
4062 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
4063 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004064 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004065 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004066 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004067 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4068 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004069 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
4070 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
4071 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004072 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004073 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
4074 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004075 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004076 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004077 Constant *C3 =
4078 Context->getConstantExprTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
4079 C3 = Context->getConstantExprAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004080 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004081 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4082 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
4083 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004084 Constant *C3 =
4085 Context->getConstantExprTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
4086 if (Context->getConstantExprAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
4087 // trunc(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004088 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
4089 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004090 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004091 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00004092 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004093
4094 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4095 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004096 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004097 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004098 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4099 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4100 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004101 }
4102
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004103 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0, Context);
4104 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1, Context);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004105
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004106 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004107 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004108
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004109 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004110 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004111 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004112 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004113 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00004114 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004115 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004116
4117 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004118 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004119 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004120 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
4121 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004122
4123 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004124 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004125 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004126 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004127 }
4128 }
4129
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004130 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004131 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
4132 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004133
4134 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004135 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004136 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004137 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004138 }
4139 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004140
4141 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004142 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004143 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
4144 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4145 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4146 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
4147 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
4148 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4149 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4150 }
4151 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004152
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004153 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004154 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004155 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
4156 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
4157 std::swap(A, B);
4158 }
4159 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00004160 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004161 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004162 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004163 }
4164 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004165
4166 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004167 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A)), *Context) ||
4168 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1))), *Context))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004169 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004170 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A)), *Context) ||
4171 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0))), *Context))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004172 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004173 }
4174
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004175 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4176 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004177 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS),Context))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004178 return R;
4179
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004180 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4181 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4182 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004183 }
4184
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004185 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004186 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4187 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4188 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4189 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00004190 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004191 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004192 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4193 I.getType(), TD) &&
4194 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4195 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004196 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004197 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4198 I.getName());
4199 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004200 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004201 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004202 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004203
4204 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004205 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4206 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4207 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004208 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4209 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4210 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004211 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004212 SI1->getOperand(0),
4213 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004214 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004215 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004216 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004217 }
4218
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004219 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004220 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4221 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4222 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004223 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
4224 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004225 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4226 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4227 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4228 // false.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004229 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004231 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
4232 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004233 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004234 } else {
4235 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4236 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004237 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS),
4238 m_Value(Op0RHS)), *Context) &&
4239 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS),
4240 m_Value(Op1RHS)), *Context)) {
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00004241 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4242 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4243 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4244 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4245 }
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004246 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4247 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4248 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004249 return new FCmpInst(*Context, (FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
4250 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004251 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE ||
4252 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004253 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004254 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4255 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4256 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4257 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4258 bool Op0Ordered;
4259 bool Op1Ordered;
4260 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4261 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4262 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
4263 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4264 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
4265 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
4266 }
4267 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
4268 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
4269 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
4270 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
4271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4272 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4273 // uno && ord -> false
4274 if (!Op0Ordered)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004275 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004276 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4277 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004278 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context));
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004279 }
4280 }
4281 }
4282 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004283 }
4284 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004285
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004286 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004287}
4288
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004289/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4290/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4291/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4292/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4293/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4294/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4295/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4296/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4297/// match.
4298///
4299/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4300/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4301/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4302/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4303/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4304/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4305///
4306/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4307/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4308/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4309/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4310/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4311///
4312static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4313 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4314 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4315 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4316 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4317 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4318 ByteValues) ||
4319 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4320 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004321 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004322
4323 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4324 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4325 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4326 unsigned ShAmt =
4327 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4328 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4329 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4330 return true;
4331
4332 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4333 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4334 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4335 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4336 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4337 } else {
4338 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4339 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4340 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004341 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004342 }
4343
4344 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4345 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4346
4347 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4348 ByteValues);
4349 }
4350
4351 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4352 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4353 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4354 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4355 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4356 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4357 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4358 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4359
4360 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4361 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4362 // the and mask is.
4363 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4364 continue;
4365
4366 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4367 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4368 if (MaskB == 0) {
4369 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4370 continue;
4371 }
4372
4373 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4374 if (MaskB != Byte)
4375 return true;
4376
4377 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4378 }
4379
4380 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4381 ByteValues);
4382 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004383 }
4384
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004385 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4386 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4387 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4388 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4389 // their ultimate destination.
4390 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4391 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004392
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004393 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4394 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4395 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4396 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4397 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4398 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4399 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4400 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4401 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4402 return true;
4403 } else {
4404 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4405 return true;
4406 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004407
4408 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4409 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004410 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004411 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004412 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004413 return false;
4414}
4415
4416/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4417/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4418Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004419 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004420 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4421 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4422 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004423 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004424
4425 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4426 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004427 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004428 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004429
4430 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004431 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4432 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004433 return 0;
4434
4435 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4436 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4437 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4438
4439 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4440 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4441 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4442 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004443 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004444 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004445 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004446 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004447}
4448
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004449/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4450/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4451/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4452static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004453 Value *C, Value *D,
4454 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004455 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004456 Value *Cond = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004457 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond)), *Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004458 return 0;
4459
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004460 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004461 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond)), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004462 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004463 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond))), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004464 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4465 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004466 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond)), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004467 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004468 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond))), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004469 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004470 return 0;
4471}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004472
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004473/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4474Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4475 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4476 Value *Val, *Val2;
4477 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4478 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4479
4480 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004481 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
4482 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst)), *Context) ||
4483 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
4484 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst)), *Context))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004485 return 0;
4486
4487 // From here on, we only handle:
4488 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4489 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4490
4491 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4492 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4493 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4494 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4495 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4496 return 0;
4497
4498 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4499 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4500 return 0;
4501
4502 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4503 bool ShouldSwap;
4504 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4505 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4506 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4507 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4508 else
4509 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4510
4511 if (ShouldSwap) {
4512 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4513 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4514 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4515 }
4516
4517 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4518 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4519 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4520 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4521 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4522 // equal.
4523 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4524
4525 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004526 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004527 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4528 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004529 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004530 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004531 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)) {
4532 // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4533 Constant *AddCST = Context->getConstantExprNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004534 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
4535 Val->getName()+".off");
4536 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004537 AddCST = Context->getConstantExprSub(AddOne(RHSCst, Context), LHSCst);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004538 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004539 }
4540 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4541 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4542 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4543 break;
4544 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4547 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4548 }
4549 break;
4550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4551 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004552 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004553 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4554 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4555 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004561 }
4562 break;
4563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4564 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004565 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004566 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4567 break;
4568 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4569 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4570 // this can cause overflow.
4571 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4572 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004573 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst, Context),
4574 false, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004575 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4576 break;
4577 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4578 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4579 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4580 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4581 break;
4582 }
4583 break;
4584 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4585 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004586 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004587 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4588 break;
4589 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4590 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4591 // this can cause overflow.
4592 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004594 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst, Context),
4595 true, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004596 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4597 break;
4598 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4599 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4600 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4601 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4602 break;
4603 }
4604 break;
4605 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4606 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004607 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004608 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4609 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4610 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4611 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4612 break;
4613 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4614 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004615 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004616 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4617 break;
4618 }
4619 break;
4620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4621 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004622 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004623 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4624 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4626 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4627 break;
4628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4629 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004630 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004631 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4632 break;
4633 }
4634 break;
4635 }
4636 return 0;
4637}
4638
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004639/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
4640///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004641/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004642///
4643/// into:
4644///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004645/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004646///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004647/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004648Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004649 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00004650 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4651 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004652
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004653 Value *V1 = 0;
4654 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004655 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)), *Context)) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004656
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004657 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
4658 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
4659
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004660 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004661 Instruction *NewOp =
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00004662 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1), I);
4663 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004664 }
4665
4666 return 0;
4667}
4668
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004669Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004670 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004671 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004672
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004673 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004674 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004675
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004676 // or X, X = X
4677 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004678 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004679
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004680 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4681 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004682 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4683 return &I;
4684 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4685 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4687 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4688 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
4690 }
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004691 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004692
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004693 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004694 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004695 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004696 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004697 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
4698 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004699 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004700 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004701 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004702 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004703 Context->getConstantInt(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004704 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004705
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004706 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004707 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
4708 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004709 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004710 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004711 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004712 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004713 Context->getConstantInt(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004714 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004715
4716 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4717 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004718 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004719 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004720 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4721 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4722 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004723 }
4724
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004725 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4726 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004727
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004728 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004729 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4730 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004731 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004732 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4733 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4734
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004735 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4736 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004737 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context) ||
4738 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context) ||
4739 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context) &&
4740 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004741 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4742 return BSwap;
4743 }
4744
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004745 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004746 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
4747 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004748 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004749 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004750 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4751 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004752 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004753 }
4754
4755 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004756 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
4757 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004758 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004759 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004760 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4761 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004762 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004763 }
4764
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004765 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004766 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004767 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C)), *Context) &&
4768 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004769 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4770 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4771 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4772 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4773 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4774 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4775 // replace with V+N.
4776 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4777 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004778 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004779 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4780 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4781 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4782 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4783 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4784 }
4785 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4786 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004787 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004788 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4789 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4791 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4792 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4793 }
4794 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004795 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004796 }
4797
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004798 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4799 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004800 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4801 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4802 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4803 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4804 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4805 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4806 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4807 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4808 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4809
4810 if (V1) {
4811 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004812 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4813 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004814 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004815 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004816
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004817 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004818 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004819 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004820 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004821 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004822 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004823 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004824 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004825 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004826
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004827 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004828 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D)), *Context) &&
4829 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004830 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004831 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004832 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D)), *Context) &&
4833 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004834 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004835 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004836 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B)), *Context) &&
4837 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004838 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004839 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004840 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B)), *Context) &&
4841 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004842 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004843 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004844
4845 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004846 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4847 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4848 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004849 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4850 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4851 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004852 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004853 SI1->getOperand(0),
4854 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004855 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004856 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004857 }
4858 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004859
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004860 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004861 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C)), *Context) ||
4862 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))), *Context)) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004863 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004864 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004865 }
4866 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004867 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C)), *Context) ||
4868 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))), *Context)) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004869 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004870 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004871 }
4872
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004873 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)), *Context)) { // ~A | Op1
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004874 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004875 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004876 } else {
4877 A = 0;
4878 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004879 // Note, A is still live here!
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004880 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)), *Context)) { // Op0 | ~B
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004881 if (Op0 == B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004883
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004884 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004885 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004886 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004887 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00004888 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004889 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004890 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004891
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004892 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4893 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004894 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS),Context))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004895 return R;
4896
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004897 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4898 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4899 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004900 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004901
4902 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004903 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004904 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004905 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004906 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4907 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4908 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
4909 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
4910 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4911 // generated.
4912 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4913 I.getType(), TD) &&
4914 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4915 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004916 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004917 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4918 I.getName());
4919 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004920 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004921 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004922 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004923 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004924 }
4925
4926
4927 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4928 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
4929 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
4930 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Chris Lattner5ebd9362008-02-29 06:09:11 +00004931 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004932 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004933 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4934 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4935 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4936 // true.
Chris Lattnerbe3e3482007-10-24 18:54:45 +00004937 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004938 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004939
4940 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4941 // rest.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004942 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
4943 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004944 }
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004945 } else {
4946 Value *Op0LHS, *Op0RHS, *Op1LHS, *Op1RHS;
4947 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC, Op1CC;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004948 if (match(Op0, m_FCmp(Op0CC, m_Value(Op0LHS),
4949 m_Value(Op0RHS)), *Context) &&
4950 match(Op1, m_FCmp(Op1CC, m_Value(Op1LHS),
4951 m_Value(Op1RHS)), *Context)) {
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004952 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4953 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4954 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4955 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4956 }
4957 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4958 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4959 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004960 return new FCmpInst(*Context, (FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
4961 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004962 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE ||
4963 Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004965 else if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4966 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
4967 else if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4968 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4969 bool Op0Ordered;
4970 bool Op1Ordered;
4971 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4972 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4973 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4974 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4975 // or'ed predicates.
4976 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004977 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context);
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00004978 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4979 return I;
4980 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4981 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4982 }
4983 }
4984 }
4985 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004986 }
4987 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004988
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004989 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004990}
4991
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00004992namespace {
4993
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00004994// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
4995struct XorSelf {
4996 Value *RHS;
4997 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
4998 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
4999 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
5000 return &Xor;
5001 }
5002};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005003
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005004}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005005
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005006Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005007 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005008 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005009
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005010 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
5011 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
5012 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
5013 // idiom (misuse).
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005014 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005015 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005016 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005017
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005018 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005019 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1), Context)) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00005020 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005021 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005022 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005023
5024 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5025 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005026 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5027 return &I;
5028 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
5029 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
5030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005031
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005032 // Is this a ~ operation?
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005033 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005034 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5035 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5036 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
5037 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
5038 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005039 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1), Context)) Op0I->swapOperands();
5040 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0), Context)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005041 Instruction *NotY =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005042 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005043 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
5044 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
5045 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005046 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005047 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005048 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005049 }
5050 }
5051 }
5052 }
5053
5054
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005055 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005056 if (RHS == Context->getConstantIntTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00005057 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005058 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005059 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI->getInversePredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005060 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00005061
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005062 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005063 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCI->getInversePredicate(),
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005064 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
5065 }
5066
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005067 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
5068 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5069 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
5070 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
5071 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
5072 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005073 if (RHS == Context->getConstantExprCast(Opcode,
5074 Context->getConstantIntTrue(),
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005075 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
5076 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005077 *Context,
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005078 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
5079 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
5080 NewCI->takeName(CI);
5081 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
5082 }
5083 }
5084 }
5085 }
5086 }
5087
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005088 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00005089 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005090 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
5091 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005092 Constant *NegOp0I0C = Context->getConstantExprNeg(Op0I0C);
5093 Constant *ConstantRHS = Context->getConstantExprSub(NegOp0I0C,
5094 Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005095 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005096 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005097
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005098 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005099 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00005100 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005101 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005102 Constant *NegOp0CI = Context->getConstantExprNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005103 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005104 Context->getConstantExprSub(NegOp0CI,
5105 Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1)),
5106 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00005107 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005108 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005109 Constant *C =
5110 Context->getConstantInt(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005111 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00005112
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005113 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005114 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
5115 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005116 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005117 Constant *NewRHS = Context->getConstantExprOr(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005118 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
5119 // NewRHS.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005120 Constant *CommonBits = Context->getConstantExprAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
5121 NewRHS = Context->getConstantExprAnd(NewRHS,
5122 Context->getConstantExprNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00005123 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005124 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
5125 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
5126 return &I;
5127 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00005128 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005129 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00005130 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005131
5132 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5133 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005134 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005135 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005136 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5137 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5138 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005139 }
5140
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005141 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0, Context)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005142 if (X == Op1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005143 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005144
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005145 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1, Context)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005146 if (X == Op0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005147 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005148
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005149
5150 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
5151 if (Op1I) {
5152 Value *A, *B;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005153 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005154 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005155 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005156 I.swapOperands();
5157 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005158 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005159 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005160 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005161 }
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005162 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005164 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005166 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5167 Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005168 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005169 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005170 std::swap(A, B);
5171 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005172 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005173 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
5174 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
5175 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00005176 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005177 }
5178
5179 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5180 if (Op0I) {
5181 Value *A, *B;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005182 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5183 Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005184 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
5185 std::swap(A, B);
5186 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5187 Instruction *NotB =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005188 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
5189 Op1, "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005190 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005191 }
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005192 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005193 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005194 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005196 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5197 Op0I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005198 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5199 std::swap(A, B);
5200 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005201 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005202 Instruction *N =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005203 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, A, "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005204 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005205 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005206 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005207 }
5208
5209 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5210 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5211 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5212 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5213 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
5214 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005215 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005216 Op1I->getOperand(0),
5217 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005218 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005219 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5220 }
5221
5222 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5223 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5224 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005225 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5226 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005227 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005228 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005229 }
5230 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005231 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5232 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005233 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005234 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005235 }
5236
5237 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5238 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005239 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5240 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005241 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5242 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5243 if (A == C)
5244 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5245 else if (A == D)
5246 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5247 else if (B == C)
5248 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5249 else if (B == D)
5250 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5251
5252 if (X) {
5253 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005254 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
5255 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005256 }
5257 }
5258 }
5259
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005260 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5261 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005262 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS),Context))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005263 return R;
5264
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005265 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005266 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005267 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005268 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5269 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005270 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005271 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005272 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5273 I.getType(), TD) &&
5274 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5275 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005276 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005277 Op1C->getOperand(0),
5278 I.getName());
5279 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005280 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005281 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005282 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005283 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005284
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005285 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005286}
5287
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005288static ConstantInt *ExtractElement(Constant *V, Constant *Idx,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005289 LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005290 return cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprExtractElement(V, Idx));
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005291}
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005292
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005293static bool HasAddOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5294 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5295 bool IsSigned) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005296 if (IsSigned)
5297 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5298 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5299 else
5300 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5301 else
5302 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005303}
5304
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005305/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005306/// overflowed for this type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005307static bool AddWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005308 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005309 bool IsSigned = false) {
5310 Result = Context->getConstantExprAdd(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005311
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005312 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5313 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005314 Constant *Idx = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i);
5315 if (HasAddOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5316 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5317 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005318 IsSigned))
5319 return true;
5320 }
5321 return false;
5322 }
5323
5324 return HasAddOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5325 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5326 IsSigned);
5327}
5328
5329static bool HasSubOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5330 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5331 bool IsSigned) {
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005332 if (IsSigned)
5333 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5334 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5335 else
5336 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5337 else
5338 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5339}
5340
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005341/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5342/// overflowed for this type.
5343static bool SubWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005344 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005345 bool IsSigned = false) {
5346 Result = Context->getConstantExprSub(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005347
5348 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5349 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005350 Constant *Idx = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i);
5351 if (HasSubOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5352 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5353 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005354 IsSigned))
5355 return true;
5356 }
5357 return false;
5358 }
5359
5360 return HasSubOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5361 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5362 IsSigned);
5363}
5364
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005365/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5366/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5367/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5368static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
5369 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5370 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005371 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005372 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005373 Value *Result = Context->getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005374
5375 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005376 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005377 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005378
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005379 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5380 ++i, ++GTI) {
5381 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005382 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005383 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5384 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5385
5386 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5387 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5388 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5389
5390 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005391 Result =
5392 Context->getConstantInt(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005393 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005394 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005395 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005396 Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, Size),
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005397 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5398 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005399 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005400
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005401 Constant *Scale = Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, Size);
5402 Constant *OC =
5403 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5404 Scale = Context->getConstantExprMul(OC, Scale);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005405 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005406 Result = Context->getConstantExprAdd(RC, Scale);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005407 else {
5408 // Emit an add instruction.
5409 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005410 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005411 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005412 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005413 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005414 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005415 // Convert to correct type.
5416 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5417 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005418 Op = Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005419 else
Chris Lattner62ce3b32009-04-07 05:03:34 +00005420 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(Op, IntPtrTy,
5421 true,
5422 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005423 }
5424 if (Size != 1) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005425 Constant *Scale = Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005426 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005427 Op = Context->getConstantExprMul(OpC, Scale);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005428 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005429 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005430 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5431 }
5432
5433 // Emit an add instruction.
5434 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005435 Result = Context->getConstantExprAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005436 cast<Constant>(Result));
5437 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005438 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005439 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005440 }
5441 return Result;
5442}
5443
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005444
Dan Gohman8f080f02009-07-17 22:16:21 +00005445/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return a value that can be used to compare
5446/// the *offset* implied by a GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we
5447/// want to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can
5448/// be complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be
5449/// legal to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32).
5450/// This later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed
5451/// to generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005452///
5453/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5454///
5455static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5456 InstCombiner &IC) {
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005457 TargetData &TD = IC.getTargetData();
5458 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5459
5460 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5461 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5462 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5463 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5464 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5465 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5466 int64_t Offset = 0;
5467 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5468 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5469 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5470 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5471
5472 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5473 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5474 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5475 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005476 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005477 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5478 }
5479 } else {
5480 // Found our variable index.
5481 break;
5482 }
5483 }
5484
5485 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5486 // evaluate it the general way.
5487 if (i == e) return 0;
5488
5489 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5490 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5491 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005492 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005493
5494 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5495 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5496 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5497 if (!CI) return 0;
5498
5499 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5500 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5501
5502 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5503 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5504 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5505 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005506 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005507 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5508 }
5509 }
5510
5511 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5512 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5513 // the index.
5514 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5515 if (Offset == 0) {
5516 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5517 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5518 // computation crosses zero.
5519 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5520 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5521 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5522 return VariableIdx;
5523 }
5524
5525 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5526 // the pointer size, so get it.
5527 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5528
5529 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5530 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5531
5532 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5533 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5534 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5535 // multiple of the variable scale.
5536 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5537 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5538 return 0;
5539
5540 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5541 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5542 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005543 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005544 true /*SExt*/,
5545 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005546 Constant *OffsetVal = IC.getContext()->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005547 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005548}
5549
5550
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005551/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005552/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005553Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5554 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5555 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005556 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005557
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005558 // Look through bitcasts.
5559 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5560 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005561
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005562 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
5563 if (PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005564 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005565 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5566 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5567 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5568
5569 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5570 if (Offset == 0)
5571 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005572 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005573 Context->getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005574 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005575 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5576 // compare the base pointer.
5577 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5578 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005579 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005580 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005581 if (IndicesTheSame)
5582 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5583 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5584 IndicesTheSame = false;
5585 break;
5586 }
5587
5588 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5589 if (IndicesTheSame)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005590 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005591 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005592
5593 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5594 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005595 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005596 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005597
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005598 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5599 bool AllZeros = true;
5600 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5601 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5602 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5603 AllZeros = false;
5604 break;
5605 }
5606 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005607 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5608 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005609
5610 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005611 AllZeros = true;
5612 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5613 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5614 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5615 AllZeros = false;
5616 break;
5617 }
5618 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005619 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005620
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005621 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5622 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5623 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5624 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5625 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5626 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005627 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5628 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005629 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005630 NumDifferences = 2;
5631 break;
5632 } else {
5633 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5634 DiffOperand = i;
5635 }
5636 }
5637
5638 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005640 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005641 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005642
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005643 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005644 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5645 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005646 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005647 return new ICmpInst(*Context,
5648 ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005649 }
5650 }
5651
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005652 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005653 // the result to fold to a constant!
5654 if ((isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
5655 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5656 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5657 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5658 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005659 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005660 }
5661 }
5662 return 0;
5663}
5664
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005665/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5666///
5667Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5668 Instruction *LHSI,
5669 Constant *RHSC) {
5670 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5671 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5672
5673 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5674 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005675 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005676 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5677
5678 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5679 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5680 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005681 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005682
5683 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005684 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5685 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005686 ++InputSize;
5687
5688 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5689 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5690 return 0;
5691
5692 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5693 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5694 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5695 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5696
5697 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5698 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005699 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected predicate!");
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005700 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005701 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5702 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5703 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005704 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005705 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5706 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5707 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005708 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005709 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5710 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5711 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005712 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005713 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5714 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5715 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005716 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005717 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5718 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5719 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005720 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005721 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5722 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5723 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005724 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005725 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005726 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005727 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005728 }
5729
5730 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5731
5732 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5733
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005734 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005735 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005736 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005737
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005738 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5739 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5740 // and large values.
5741 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5742 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5743 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5744 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5745 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5746 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005747 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
5748 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005749 }
5750 } else {
5751 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5752 // +INF and large values.
5753 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5754 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5755 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5756 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5757 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5758 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005759 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
5760 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005761 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005762 }
5763
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005764 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5765 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5766 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5767 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5768 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5769 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5770 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5771 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005772 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
5773 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005774 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005775 }
5776
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005777 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5778 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5779 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5780 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005781 Constant *RHSInt = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005782 ? Context->getConstantExprFPToUI(RHSC, IntTy)
5783 : Context->getConstantExprFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005784 if (!RHS.isZero()) {
5785 bool Equal = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005786 ? Context->getConstantExprUIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC
5787 : Context->getConstantExprSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC;
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005788 if (!Equal) {
5789 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5790 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5791 // zero at this point.
5792 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005793 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer comparison!");
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005794 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005795 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005796 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005797 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005798 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5799 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5800 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5801 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005803 break;
5804 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5805 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5806 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5807 if (RHS.isNegative())
5808 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5809 break;
5810 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5811 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5812 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5813 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005815 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5816 break;
5817 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5818 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5819 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5820 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5821 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5822 break;
5823 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5824 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5825 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5826 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005827 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005828 break;
5829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5830 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5831 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5832 if (RHS.isNegative())
5833 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5834 break;
5835 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5836 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5837 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5838 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005839 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005840 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5841 break;
5842 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5843 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5844 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5845 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5846 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5847 break;
5848 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005849 }
5850 }
5851
5852 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5853 // comparison.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005854 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005855}
5856
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005857Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5858 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005859 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005860
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005861 // Fold trivial predicates.
5862 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005863 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005864 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005866
5867 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5868 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5869 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005870 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown predicate!");
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005871 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5872 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5873 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005874 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005875 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5876 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5877 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005878 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005879
5880 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5881 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5882 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5883 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5884 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5885 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005886 I.setOperand(1, Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005887 return &I;
5888
5889 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5890 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5891 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5892 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5893 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5894 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005895 I.setOperand(1, Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005896 return &I;
5897 }
5898 }
5899
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005900 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005901 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getUndef(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005902
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005903 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5904 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005905 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5906 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5907 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5908 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005909 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005910 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5911 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5912 // True if unordered.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005913 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005914 }
5915 }
5916
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005917 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5918 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5919 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005920 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5921 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5922 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5923 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5924 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5925 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005926 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005927 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5928 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5929 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5930 return NV;
5931 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005932 case Instruction::Select:
5933 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5934 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5935 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5936 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5937 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5938 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5939 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005940 Op1 = Context->getConstantExprCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005941 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005942 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005943 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5944 I.getName()), I);
5945 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5946 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005947 Op2 = Context->getConstantExprCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005948 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005949 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005950 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5951 I.getName()), I);
5952 }
5953 }
5954
5955 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005956 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005957 break;
5958 }
5959 }
5960
5961 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5962}
5963
5964Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5965 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5966 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5967 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5968
5969 // icmp X, X
5970 if (Op0 == Op1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005971 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005972 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005973
5974 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getUndef(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005976
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005977 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005978 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005979 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5980 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5981 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005982 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005983 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005984 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005985
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005986 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00005987 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005988 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005989 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005990 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005991 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005992 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005993 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005994 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005995 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005996 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005997
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005998 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00005999 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006000 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006001 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006002 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6003 Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006004 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006005 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006006 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6008 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006009 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006010 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006011 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6012 Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006013 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
6014 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
6015 }
6016 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6017 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
6018 // FALL THROUGH
6019 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006020 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6021 Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006022 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006023 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006024 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006025 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6026 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
6027 // FALL THROUGH
6028 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006029 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6030 Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006031 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
6032 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
6033 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006034 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006035 }
6036
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006037 unsigned BitWidth = 0;
6038 if (TD)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00006039 BitWidth = TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty->getScalarType());
6040 else if (Ty->isIntOrIntVector())
6041 BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006042
6043 bool isSignBit = false;
6044
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006045 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006046 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky579214a2009-02-27 06:37:39 +00006047 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006048
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006049 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
6050 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006051 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006052 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006053 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00006054 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006055
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006056 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
6057 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
6058 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006059 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
6060 default: break;
6061 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6062 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006063 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006064 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0,
6065 AddOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006066 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6067 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006068 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006069 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
6070 AddOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006071 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6072 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006073 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006074 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0,
6075 SubOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006076 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6077 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006078 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006079 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
6080 SubOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006081 }
6082
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006083 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006084 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006085 bool UnusedBit;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006086 isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
6087 }
6088
6089 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
6090 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
6091 if (BitWidth != 0) {
6092 APInt Op0KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op0KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6093 APInt Op1KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op1KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6094
6095 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(0),
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006096 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
6097 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006098 Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne, 0))
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006099 return &I;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006100 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(1),
6101 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
6102 Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne, 0))
6103 return &I;
6104
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006105 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006106 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
6107 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006108 APInt Op0Min(BitWidth, 0), Op0Max(BitWidth, 0);
6109 APInt Op1Min(BitWidth, 0), Op1Max(BitWidth, 0);
6110 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
6111 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6112 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6113 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6114 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6115 } else {
6116 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6117 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6118 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6119 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6120 }
6121
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006122 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
6123 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
6124 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006125 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0) && Op0Min == Op0Max)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006126 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006127 Context->getConstantInt(Op0Min), Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006128 if (!isa<Constant>(Op1) && Op1Min == Op1Max)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006129 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006130 Context->getConstantInt(Op1Min));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006131
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006132 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
6133 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006134 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006135 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006136 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006137 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006139 break;
6140 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006141 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006142 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006143 break;
6144 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006145 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A <u B -> true if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006146 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006147 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A <u B -> false if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006148 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006149 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <u B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006150 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006151 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6152 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <u C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006153 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6154 SubOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006155
6156 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
6157 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006158 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006159 Context->getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006160 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006161 break;
6162 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006163 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A >u B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006164 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006165 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A >u B -> false if max(A) <= max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006166 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006167
6168 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >u B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006169 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006170 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6171 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >u C -> A == C+1 if max(a)-1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006172 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6173 AddOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006174
6175 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
6176 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006177 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006178 Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006179 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006180 break;
6181 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006182 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A <s B -> true if max(A) < min(C)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006184 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A <s B -> false if min(A) >= max(C)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006185 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006186 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <s B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006187 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006188 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6189 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <s C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006190 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6191 SubOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006192 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006193 break;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006194 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6195 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A >s B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006196 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006197 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A >s B -> false if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006199
6200 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >s B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006201 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006202 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6203 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >s C -> A == C+1 if max(A)-1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006204 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6205 AddOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006206 }
6207 break;
6208 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6209 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6210 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A >=s B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006212 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A >=s B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006214 break;
6215 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6216 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SLE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6217 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A <=s B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006218 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006219 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A <=s B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006220 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006221 break;
6222 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6223 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_UGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6224 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A >=u B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006225 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006226 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A >=u B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006227 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006228 break;
6229 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6230 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_ULE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6231 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A <=u B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006232 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006233 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A <=u B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006234 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006235 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006236 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006237
6238 // Turn a signed comparison into an unsigned one if both operands
6239 // are known to have the same sign.
6240 if (I.isSignedPredicate() &&
6241 ((Op0KnownZero.isNegative() && Op1KnownZero.isNegative()) ||
6242 (Op0KnownOne.isNegative() && Op1KnownOne.isNegative())))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006243 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getUnsignedPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006244 }
6245
6246 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
6247 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
6248 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
6249 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
6250 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
6251 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
6252 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
6253 if (I.hasOneUse())
6254 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
6255 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
6256 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
6257 return 0;
6258
6259 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
6260 // can be folded into the comparison.
6261 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006262 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00006263 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006264 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00006265 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006266 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
6267 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006268 }
6269
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006270 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006271 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6272 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6273 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006274 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
6275 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006276 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006277 bool isAllZeros = true;
6278 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6279 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
6280 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6281 isAllZeros = false;
6282 break;
6283 }
6284 if (isAllZeros)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006285 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006286 Context->getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006287 }
6288 break;
6289
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006290 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006291 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
6292 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6293 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6294 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
6295 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6296 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006297 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006298 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006299 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6300 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6301 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6302 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
6303 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6304 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6305 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006306 Op1 = Context->getConstantExprICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006307 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006308 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006309 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
6310 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006311 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
6312 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006313 Op2 = Context->getConstantExprICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006314 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006315 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006316 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
6317 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006318 }
6319 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00006320
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006321 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006322 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006323 break;
6324 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006325 case Instruction::Malloc:
6326 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6327 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6328 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
6329 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006330 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00006331 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006332 }
6333 break;
6334 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006335 }
6336
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006337 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006338 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006339 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006340 return NI;
6341 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006342 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6343 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006344 return NI;
6345
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006346 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006347 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6348 // now.
6349 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6350 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6351 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006352 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6353 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006354 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006355
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006356 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6357 // so eliminate it as well.
6358 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6359 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006360
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006361 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006362 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006363 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006364 Op1 = Context->getConstantExprBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006365 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006366 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006367 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006368 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006369 }
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006370 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006371 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006372 }
6373
6374 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006375 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006376 // This comes up when you have code like
6377 // int X = A < B;
6378 // if (X) ...
6379 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006380 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
6381 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006382 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006383 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006384 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006385
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006386 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6387 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6388 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006389 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006390 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1)) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006391 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006392 default: break;
6393 case Instruction::Add:
6394 case Instruction::Sub:
6395 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006396 if (I.isEquality()) // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006397 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006398 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006399 // icmp u/s (a ^ signbit), (b ^ signbit) --> icmp s/u a, b
6400 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6401 if (CI->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6402 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6403 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6404 : I.getSignedPredicate();
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006405 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006406 Op1I->getOperand(0));
6407 }
6408
6409 if (CI->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
6410 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6411 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6412 : I.getSignedPredicate();
6413 Pred = I.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006414 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006415 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006416 }
6417 }
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006418 break;
6419 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006420 if (!I.isEquality())
6421 break;
6422
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006423 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6424 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6425 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6426 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6427 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006428 ConstantInt *Mask = Context->getConstantInt(
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006429 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6430 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006431 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006432 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
6433 Mask);
6434 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
6435 Mask);
6436 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
6437 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006438 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006439 }
6440 }
6441 break;
6442 }
6443 }
6444 }
6445 }
6446
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006447 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6448 { Value *A, *B;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006449 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)), *Context) &&
6450 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006451 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B, A);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006452 }
6453
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006454 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006455 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006456
6457 // -x == -y --> x == y
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006458 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A)), *Context) &&
6459 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006460 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006461
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006462 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006463 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6464 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006465 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006466 Context->getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006467 }
6468
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006469 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006470 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006471 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006472 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1), *Context) &&
6473 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2), *Context) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006474 Constant *NC =
6475 Context->getConstantInt(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006476 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006477 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006478 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
6479 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006480
6481 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006482 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6483 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6484 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6485 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, C);
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006486 }
6487 }
6488
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006489 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006490 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006491 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6492 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006493 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006494 Context->getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006495 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006496
6497 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006498 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006499 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006500 Context->getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006501
6502 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006503 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006504 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006505 Context->getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006506
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006507 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6508 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006509 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
6510 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006511 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6512
6513 if (A == C) {
6514 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6515 } else if (A == D) {
6516 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6517 } else if (B == C) {
6518 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6519 } else if (B == D) {
6520 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6521 }
6522
6523 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006524 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6525 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006526 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006527 I.setOperand(1, Context->getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006528 return &I;
6529 }
6530 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006531 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006532 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006533}
6534
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006535
6536/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6537/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6538Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6539 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6540 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6541 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6542
6543 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6544 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6545 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6546 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6547 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6548 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6549 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6550 // if it finds it.
6551 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6552 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6553 return 0;
6554 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006555 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006556 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6557 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6558 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6559 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6560 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006561
6562 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6563 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6564 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6565 // instead of computing a divide.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006566 Constant *Prod = Context->getConstantExprMul(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006567
6568 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6569 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6570 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006571 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? Context->getConstantExprSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6572 Context->getConstantExprUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006573
6574 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006575 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006576
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006577 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6578 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6579 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6580 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6581 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6582 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6583 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6584 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00006585 Constant *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006586
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006587 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006588 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006589 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006590 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6591 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006592 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, Context, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006593 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006594 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006595 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006596 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(SubOne(DivRHS,
6597 Context)));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006598 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006599 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006600 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6601 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6602 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006603 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006604 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006605 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006606 HiBound = AddOne(Prod, Context);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006607 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6608 if (!LoOverflow) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006609 ConstantInt* DivNeg =
6610 cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(DivRHS));
6611 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg, Context,
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006612 true) ? -1 : 0;
6613 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006614 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006615 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006616 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006617 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006618 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS, Context);
6619 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006620 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6621 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6622 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6623 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006624 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006625 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006626 HiBound = AddOne(Prod, Context);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006627 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006628 if (!LoOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006629 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound,
6630 DivRHS, Context, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006631 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006632 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6633 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006634 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006635 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006636 }
6637
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006638 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6639 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006640 }
6641
6642 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006643 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006644 default: llvm_unreachable("Unhandled icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006645 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6646 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006647 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006648 else if (HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006649 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006650 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6651 else if (LoOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006652 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006653 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6654 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006655 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006656 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6657 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006658 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006659 else if (HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006660 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006661 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6662 else if (LoOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006663 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006664 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6665 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006666 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006667 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6668 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006669 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006670 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006671 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006672 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006673 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006674 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6675 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006676 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006677 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006678 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006679 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006680 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006681 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006682 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006683 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006684 }
6685}
6686
6687
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006688/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6689///
6690Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6691 Instruction *LHSI,
6692 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6693 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6694
6695 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006696 case Instruction::Trunc:
6697 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6698 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
6699 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
6700 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
6701 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6702 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
6703 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
6704 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6705
6706 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
6707 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
6708 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
6709 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
6710 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
6711 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006712 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006713 Context->getConstantInt(NewRHS));
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006714 }
6715 }
6716 break;
6717
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006718 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006719 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6720 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6721 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006722 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6723 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006724 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6725
6726 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6727 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6728 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6729 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6730 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6731 return &ICI;
6732 }
6733
6734 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6735 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6736
6737 // If so, the new one isn't.
6738 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6739
6740 if (isTrueIfPositive)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006741 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006742 SubOne(RHS, Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006743 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006744 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006745 AddOne(RHS, Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006746 }
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006747
6748 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6749 // (icmp u/s (xor A SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u A, (xor C SignBit))
6750 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6751 const APInt &SignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6752 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6753 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6754 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006755 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006756 Context->getConstantInt(RHSV ^ SignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006757 }
6758
6759 // (icmp u/s (xor A ~SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u (xor C ~SignBit), A)
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006760 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006761 const APInt &NotSignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6762 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6763 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6764 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
6765 Pred = ICI.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006766 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006767 Context->getConstantInt(RHSV ^ NotSignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006768 }
6769 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006770 }
6771 break;
6772 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6773 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6774 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6775 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6776
6777 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6778 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6779 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6780 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6781 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6782 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6783 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6784 // bit would not work.
6785 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006786 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6787 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006788 uint32_t BitWidth =
6789 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6790 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6791 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6792 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6793 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6794 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006795 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006796 Context->getConstantInt(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006797 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006798 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006799 Context->getConstantInt(NewCI));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006800 }
6801 }
6802
6803 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6804 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6805 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6806 // access.
6807 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6808 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6809 Shift = 0;
6810
6811 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6812 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6813 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6814 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6815
6816 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6817 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6818 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6819 if (ShAmt) {
6820 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6821 if (!CanFold) {
6822 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6823 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6824 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6825 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6826
6827 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6828 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6829 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6830 CanFold = true;
6831 }
6832
6833 if (CanFold) {
6834 Constant *NewCst;
6835 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006836 NewCst = Context->getConstantExprLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006837 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006838 NewCst = Context->getConstantExprShl(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006839
6840 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6841 // compared.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006842 if (Context->getConstantExpr(Shift->getOpcode(),
6843 NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006844 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6845 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6846 // result is always true or false now.
6847 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006848 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006849 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006850 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006851 } else {
6852 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6853 Constant *NewAndCST;
6854 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006855 NewAndCST = Context->getConstantExprLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006856 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006857 NewAndCST = Context->getConstantExprShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006858 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6859 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6860 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6861 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6862 return &ICI;
6863 }
6864 }
6865 }
6866
6867 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6868 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6869 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6870 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
Chris Lattnere8e49212009-03-25 00:28:58 +00006871 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6872 !isa<Constant>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006873 // Compute C << Y.
6874 Value *NS;
6875 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006876 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006877 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6878 } else {
6879 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006880 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006881 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6882 }
6883 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6884
6885 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6886 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006887 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006888 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6889
6890 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6891 return &ICI;
6892 }
6893 }
6894 break;
6895
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006896 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6897 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6898 if (!ShAmt) break;
6899
6900 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6901
6902 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6903 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6904 // simplified.
6905 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6906 break;
6907
6908 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6909 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6910 // comparison cannot succeed.
6911 Constant *Comp =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006912 Context->getConstantExprShl(Context->getConstantExprLShr(RHS, ShAmt),
6913 ShAmt);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006914 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6915 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006916 Constant *Cst = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006917 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6918 }
6919
6920 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6921 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6922 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6923 Constant *Mask =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006924 Context->getConstantInt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits,
6925 TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006926
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006927 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006928 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006929 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6930 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006931 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006932 Context->getConstantInt(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006933 }
6934 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006935
6936 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6937 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6938 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6939 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6940 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006941 Constant *Mask = Context->getConstantInt(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006942 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6943 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006944 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006945 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6946 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6947
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006948 return new ICmpInst(*Context,
6949 TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006950 And, Context->getNullValue(And->getType()));
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006951 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006952 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006953 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006954
6955 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006956 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006957 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006958 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006959 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006960
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006961 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6962 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6963 // simplified.
6964 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6965 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6966 break;
6967
6968 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006969
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006970 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6971 // comparison cannot succeed.
6972 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6973 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6974 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6975 else
6976 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6977
6978 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6979 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006980 Constant *Cst = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006981 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6982 }
6983
6984 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
6985 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
6986 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006987 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6988 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006989 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006990 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006991 Context->getConstantExprShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006992 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006993
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00006994 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006995 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6996 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006997 Constant *Mask = Context->getConstantInt(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006998
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006999 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007000 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007001 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
7002 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007003 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007004 Context->getConstantExprShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007005 }
7006 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007007 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007008
7009 case Instruction::SDiv:
7010 case Instruction::UDiv:
7011 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
7012 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
7013 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
7014 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
7015 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
7016 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007017 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
7018 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
7019 DivRHS))
7020 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007021 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007022
7023 case Instruction::Add:
7024 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
7025
7026 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
7027 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
7028 if (!LHSC) break;
7029 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
7030
7031 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
7032 .subtract(LHSV);
7033
7034 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
7035 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007036 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007037 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007038 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007039 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007040 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007041 }
7042 } else {
7043 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007044 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007045 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007046 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007047 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007048 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007049 }
7050 }
7051 }
7052 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007053 }
7054
7055 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
7056 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
7057 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7058
7059 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
7060 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
7061 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
7062 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
7063 case Instruction::SRem:
7064 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
7065 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
7066 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
7067 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
7068 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007069 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007070 BO->getName());
7071 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007072 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007073 Context->getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007074 }
7075 }
7076 break;
7077 case Instruction::Add:
7078 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
7079 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7080 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007081 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007082 Context->getConstantExprSub(RHS, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007083 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
7084 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
7085 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
7086 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
7087
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007088 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1, Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007089 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007090 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0, Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007091 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007092 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00007093 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007094 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
7095 Neg->takeName(BO);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007096 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007097 }
7098 }
7099 break;
7100 case Instruction::Xor:
7101 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
7102 // the explicit xor.
7103 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007104 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007105 Context->getConstantExprXor(RHS, BOC));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007106
7107 // FALLTHROUGH
7108 case Instruction::Sub:
7109 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
7110 if (RHSV == 0)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007111 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007112 BO->getOperand(1));
7113 break;
7114
7115 case Instruction::Or:
7116 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
7117 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
7118 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007119 Constant *NotCI = Context->getConstantExprNot(RHS);
7120 if (!Context->getConstantExprAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
7121 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
7122 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
7123 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007124 }
7125 break;
7126
7127 case Instruction::And:
7128 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7129 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
7130 // comparison can never succeed!
7131 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007132 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
7133 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
7134 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007135
7136 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
7137 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007138 return new ICmpInst(*Context, isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007139 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007140 Context->getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007141
7142 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00007143 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007144 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007145 Constant *Zero = Context->getNullValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007146 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7147 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007148 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007149 }
7150
7151 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
7152 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
7153 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007154 Constant *NegX = Context->getConstantExprNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007155 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7156 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007157 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007158 }
7159 }
7160 default: break;
7161 }
7162 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
7163 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
7164 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
7165 AddToWorkList(II);
7166 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007167 ICI.setOperand(1, Context->getConstantInt(RHSV.byteSwap()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007168 return &ICI;
7169 }
7170 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007171 }
7172 return 0;
7173}
7174
7175/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
7176/// We only handle extending casts so far.
7177///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007178Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
7179 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007180 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
7181 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007182 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007183 Value *RHSCIOp;
7184
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007185 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
7186 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
7187 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
7188 getTargetData().getPointerSizeInBits() ==
7189 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
7190 Value *RHSOp = 0;
7191 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007192 RHSOp = Context->getConstantExprIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007193 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
7194 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
7195 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
7196 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00007197 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007198 }
7199
7200 if (RHSOp)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007201 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007202 }
7203
7204 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
7205 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007206 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
7207 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00007208 return 0;
7209
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007210 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
7211 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007212
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007213 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007214 // Not an extension from the same type?
7215 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007216 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
7217 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007218
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007219 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007220 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
7221 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
7222 return 0;
7223
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007224 // Deal with equality cases early.
7225 if (ICI.isEquality())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007226 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007227
7228 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7229 // signed comparison.
7230 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007231 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007232
7233 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007234 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00007235 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007236
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007237 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
7238 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
7239 if (!CI)
7240 return 0;
7241
7242 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
7243 // reextended to DestTy.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007244 Constant *Res1 = Context->getConstantExprTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
7245 Constant *Res2 = Context->getConstantExprCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(),
7246 Res1, DestTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007247
7248 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
7249 if (Res2 == CI) {
7250 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
7251 // For example, we might have:
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007252 // %A = sext i16 %X to i32
7253 // %B = icmp ugt i32 %A, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007254 // It is incorrect to transform this into
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007255 // %B = icmp ugt i16 %X, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007256 // because %A may have negative value.
7257 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007258 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
7259 // signless.
7260 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007261 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007262 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007263 }
7264
7265 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
7266 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
7267
7268 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
7269 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
7270 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007271 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007272 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007273 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantIntTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007274
7275 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
7276 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
7277 Value *Result;
7278 if (isSignedCmp) {
7279 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00007280 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007281 Result = Context->getConstantIntFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007282 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007283 Result = Context->getConstantIntTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007284 } else {
7285 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
7286 if (isSignedExt) {
7287 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
7288 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00007289 Constant *NegOne = Context->getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007290 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT,
7291 LHSCIOp, NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007292 } else {
7293 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007294 Result = Context->getConstantIntTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007295 }
7296 }
7297
7298 // Finally, return the value computed.
7299 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007300 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007301 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007302
7303 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
7304 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
7305 "ICmp should be folded!");
7306 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007307 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantExprNot(CI));
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00007308 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007309}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007310
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007311Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
7312 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7313}
7314
7315Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
7316 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7317}
7318
7319Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007320 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
7321 return R;
7322
7323 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
7324
7325 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
7326 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
7327 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
7328 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007329
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007330 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
7331 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
7332 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
7333 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
7334
7335 // Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
7336 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
7337 if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
7338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007339
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007340 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007341}
7342
7343Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
7344 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007345 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007346
7347 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
7348 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007349 if (Op1 == Context->getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
7350 Op0 == Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00007351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007352
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007353 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
7354 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00007355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007356 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007358 }
7359 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007360 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
7361 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
7362 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007364 }
7365
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007366 // See if we can fold away this shift.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007367 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007368 return &I;
7369
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007370 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7371 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
7372 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007373 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007374 return R;
7375
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007376 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007377 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
7378 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007379 return 0;
7380}
7381
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007382Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007383 BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00007384 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007385
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007386 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
7387 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007388 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007389
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007390 // shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
7391 // a signed shift.
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007392 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007393 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007394 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007396 else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007397 I.setOperand(1, Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007398 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007399 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007400 }
7401
7402 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7403 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7404 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7405 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007406 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007407 Context->getConstantExprShl(BOOp, Op1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007408
7409 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7410 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7411 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7412 return R;
7413 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7414 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7415 return NV;
7416
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007417 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7418 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7419 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7420 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7421 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7422 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7423 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7424 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7425 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7426 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7427 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007428 Constant *ShAmt = Context->getConstantExprZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007429 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007430 I.getName());
7431 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7432
7433 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7434 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7435 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7436 // other xforms later if dead.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007437 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7438 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007439 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7440
7441 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7442 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7443 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7444 // mask as appropriate.
7445 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7446 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7447 else {
7448 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7449 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7450 }
7451
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007452 Instruction *And =
7453 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, Context->getConstantInt(MaskV),
7454 TI->getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007455 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
7456
7457 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7458 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7459 }
7460 }
7461
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007462 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007463 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7464 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7465 Value *V1, *V2;
7466 ConstantInt *CC;
7467 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007468 default: break;
7469 case Instruction::Add:
7470 case Instruction::And:
7471 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007472 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007473 // These operators commute.
7474 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007475 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007476 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
7477 m_Specific(Op1)), *Context)){
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007478 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007479 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007480 Op0BO->getName());
7481 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007482 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007483 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007484 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007485 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007486 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007487 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007488 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007489 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007490
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007491 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007492 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007493 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007494 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007495 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007496 m_ConstantInt(CC)), *Context) &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007497 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007498 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007499 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7500 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007501 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7502 Instruction *XM =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007503 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1,
7504 Context->getConstantExprShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007505 V1->getName()+".mask");
7506 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7507
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007508 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007509 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007510 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007511
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007512 // FALL THROUGH.
7513 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007514 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007515 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007516 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
7517 m_Specific(Op1)), *Context)){
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007518 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007519 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7520 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007521 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007522 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007523 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007524 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007525 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007526 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007527 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007528 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007529 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007530
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007531 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007532 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7533 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7534 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007535 m_ConstantInt(CC)), *Context) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007536 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7537 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007538 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007539 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7540 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007541 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7542 Instruction *XM =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007543 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1,
7544 Context->getConstantExprShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007545 V1->getName()+".mask");
7546 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7547
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007548 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007549 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007550
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007551 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007552 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007553 }
7554
7555
7556 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7557 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7558 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7559 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7560 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7561
7562 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007563 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007564 case Instruction::Add:
7565 isValid = isLeftShift;
7566 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007567 case Instruction::Or:
7568 case Instruction::Xor:
7569 highBitSet = false;
7570 break;
7571 case Instruction::And:
7572 highBitSet = true;
7573 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007574 }
7575
7576 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7577 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7578 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7579 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7580 // operation.
7581 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007582 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007583 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007584
7585 if (isValid) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007586 Constant *NewRHS = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007587
7588 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007589 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007590 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007591 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007592
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007593 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007594 NewRHS);
7595 }
7596 }
7597 }
7598 }
7599
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007600 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007601 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7602 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7603 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007604
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007605 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007606 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007607 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7608 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007609 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7610 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7611 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007612
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007613 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007614
7615 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7616
7617 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007618 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007619 // If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
7620 // saturates.
7621 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
7622 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007624 AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
7625 }
7626
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007627 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007628 Context->getConstantInt(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007629 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7630 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007631 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007632 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007633
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007634 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007635 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007636 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7637 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7638 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007639 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
7640 AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
7641
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007642 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007643 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007644 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7645
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007646 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007647 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007648 }
7649
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007650 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7651 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7652 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7653 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7654 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007655 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007656 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007657 }
7658 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7659 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007660 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007661 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007662 }
7663 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7664 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7665 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7666 // generators.
7667 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7668 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007669 case 1 :
7670 case 8 :
7671 case 16 :
7672 case 32 :
7673 case 64 :
7674 case 128:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007675 SExtType = Context->getIntegerType(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007676 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007677 default: break;
7678 }
7679 if (SExtType) {
7680 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7681 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7682 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7683 }
7684 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7685 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007686 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007687
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007688 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007689 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7690 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7691 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007692 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007693 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007694 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7695
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007696 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007697 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007698 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007699
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007700 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007701 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7702 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7703 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007704 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007705 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007706
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007707 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007708 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007709 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007710
7711 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7712 } else {
7713 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007714 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007715
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007716 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007717 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7718 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7719 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7720 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007721 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007722 Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007723 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7724
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007725 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007726 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007727 }
7728
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007729 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007730 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7731 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7732 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007733 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007734 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7735
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007736 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007737 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007738 }
7739
7740 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007741 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007742 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007743 return 0;
7744}
7745
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007746
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007747/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7748/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7749/// X*Scale+Offset.
7750///
7751static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00007752 int &Offset, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007753 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007754 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007755 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007756 Scale = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007757 return Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007758 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7759 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7760 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7761 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7762 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7763 Offset = 0;
7764 return I->getOperand(0);
7765 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7766 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7767 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7768 Offset = 0;
7769 return I->getOperand(0);
7770 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7771 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7772 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7773 unsigned SubScale;
7774 Value *SubVal =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007775 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale,
7776 Offset, Context);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007777 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7778 Scale = SubScale;
7779 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007780 }
7781 }
7782 }
7783
7784 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7785 Scale = 1;
7786 Offset = 0;
7787 return Val;
7788}
7789
7790
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007791/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7792/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007793Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007794 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007795 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007796
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007797 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7798 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007799
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007800 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7801 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7802 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7803 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7804 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7805
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007806 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007807 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007808 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007809 }
7810 }
7811
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007812 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7813 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7814 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7815 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007816
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007817 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7818 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007819 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7820
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007821 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7822 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007823 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds. (A reference
7824 // from a dbg.declare doesn't count as a use for this purpose.)
7825 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && !hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI) &&
7826 CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007827
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00007828 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AllocElTy);
7829 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007830 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007831
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007832 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7833 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007834 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7835 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007836 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007837 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale,
7838 ArrayOffset, Context);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007839
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007840 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7841 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007842 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7843 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007844
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007845 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7846 Value *Amt = 0;
7847 if (Scale == 1) {
7848 Amt = NumElements;
7849 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007850 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007851 Amt = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007852 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007853 Amt = Context->getConstantExprMul(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007854 cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007855 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +00007856 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007857 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007858 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007859 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007860 }
7861
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007862 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007863 Value *Off = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007864 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007865 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7866 }
7867
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007868 AllocationInst *New;
7869 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +00007870 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007871 else
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +00007872 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007873 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007874 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007875
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007876 // If the allocation has one real use plus a dbg.declare, just remove the
7877 // declare.
7878 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI)) {
7879 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
7880 }
7881 // If the allocation has multiple real uses, insert a cast and change all
7882 // things that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it
7883 // will die soon.
7884 else if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007885 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007886 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7887 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7888 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007889 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7890 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7891 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007892 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7893}
7894
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007895/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007896/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7897/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7898/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7899/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7900///
7901/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7902/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007903///
7904/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7905/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7906/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7907/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7908/// efficiently truncated.
7909///
7910/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7911/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7912/// the final result.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007913bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007914 unsigned CastOpc,
7915 int &NumCastsRemoved){
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007916 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007917 if (isa<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007918 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007919
7920 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007921 if (!I) return false;
7922
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007923 const Type *OrigTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007924
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007925 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7926 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7927 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7928 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7929 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7930 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7931 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7932 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007933 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007934 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7935 return true;
7936 }
7937 }
7938
7939 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7940 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7941 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7942
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007943 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7944 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007945 case Instruction::Add:
7946 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007947 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007948 case Instruction::And:
7949 case Instruction::Or:
7950 case Instruction::Xor:
7951 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007952 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007953 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007954 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007955 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007956
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007957 case Instruction::UDiv:
7958 case Instruction::URem: {
7959 // UDiv and URem can be truncated if all the truncated bits are zero.
7960 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7961 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7962 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth) {
7963 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth);
7964 if (MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask) &&
7965 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask)) {
7966 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7967 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7968 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7969 NumCastsRemoved);
7970 }
7971 }
7972 break;
7973 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007974 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007975 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7976 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7977 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007978 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7979 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007980 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007981 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007982 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007983 }
7984 break;
7985 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007986 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
7987 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
7988 // already zeros.
7989 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007990 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7991 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007992 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007993 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007994 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
7995 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007996 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007997 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007998 }
7999 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008000 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008001 case Instruction::ZExt:
8002 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008003 case Instruction::Trunc:
8004 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00008005 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
8006 // of casts in the input.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008007 if (Opc == CastOpc)
8008 return true;
8009
8010 // sext (zext ty1), ty2 -> zext ty2
Evan Cheng661d9c32009-01-15 17:09:07 +00008011 if (CastOpc == Instruction::SExt && Opc == Instruction::ZExt)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008012 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008013 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008014 case Instruction::Select: {
8015 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
8016 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008017 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008018 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008019 NumCastsRemoved);
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008020 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008021 case Instruction::PHI: {
8022 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
8023 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8024 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
8025 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008026 NumCastsRemoved))
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008027 return false;
8028 return true;
8029 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008030 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008031 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
8032 break;
8033 }
8034
8035 return false;
8036}
8037
8038/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
8039/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
8040/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008041Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008042 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008043 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008044 return Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(C, Ty,
8045 isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008046
8047 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
8048 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00008049 Instruction *Res = 0;
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008050 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
8051 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008052 case Instruction::Add:
8053 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00008054 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008055 case Instruction::And:
8056 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008057 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008058 case Instruction::AShr:
8059 case Instruction::LShr:
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00008060 case Instruction::Shl:
8061 case Instruction::UDiv:
8062 case Instruction::URem: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008063 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008064 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008065 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)Opc, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008066 break;
8067 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008068 case Instruction::Trunc:
8069 case Instruction::ZExt:
8070 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008071 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008072 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
8073 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008074 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
8075 return I->getOperand(0);
8076
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008077 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008078 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008079 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008080 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008081 case Instruction::Select: {
8082 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
8083 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
8084 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
8085 break;
8086 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008087 case Instruction::PHI: {
8088 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8089 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
8090 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8091 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
8092 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
8093 }
8094 Res = NPN;
8095 break;
8096 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008097 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008098 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008099 llvm_unreachable("Unreachable!");
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008100 break;
8101 }
8102
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008103 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008104 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
8105}
8106
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008107/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
8108Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00008109 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8110
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00008111 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008112 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008113 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008114 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
8115 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
8116 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
8117 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008118 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00008119 }
8120 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00008121
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008122 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008123 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
8124 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
8125 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008126
8127 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008128 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
8129 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
8130 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008131
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008132 return 0;
8133}
8134
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008135/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
8136/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008137/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
8138/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
8139static const Type *FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
8140 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008141 const TargetData *TD,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008142 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008143 if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008144
8145 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
8146 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
8147 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
8148 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
8149 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008150 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008151 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00008152 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008153
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008154 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008155 if (Offset < 0) {
8156 --FirstIdx;
8157 Offset += TySize;
8158 assert(Offset >= 0);
8159 }
8160 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
8161 }
8162
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008163 NewIndices.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008164
8165 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
8166 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008167 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
8168 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008169 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008170
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008171 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
8172 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008173 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
8174 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
8175
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008176 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008177 NewIndices.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008178
8179 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
8180 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008181 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008182 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008183 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008184 NewIndices.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008185 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008186 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008187 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008188 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008189 return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008190 }
8191 }
8192
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008193 return Ty;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008194}
8195
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008196/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
8197Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8198 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8199
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008200 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008201 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
8202 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008203 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8204 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
8205 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
8206 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008207 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008208 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
8209 return &CI;
8210 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008211
8212 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
8213 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
8214 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
8215 // non-type-safe code.
8216 if (GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
8217 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
8218 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008219 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
8220 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008221 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
8222
8223 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
8224 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
8225 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
8226 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008227 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008228 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008229 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
8230 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
8231 // two.
8232 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
8233 NewIndices.begin(),
8234 NewIndices.end(), "");
8235 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
8236 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008237
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008238 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
8239 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
8240 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
8241 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008242 }
8243 }
8244 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008245 }
8246
8247 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8248}
8249
Chris Lattnerddfa57b2009-04-08 05:41:03 +00008250/// isSafeIntegerType - Return true if this is a basic integer type, not a crazy
8251/// type like i42. We don't want to introduce operations on random non-legal
8252/// integer types where they don't already exist in the code. In the future,
8253/// we should consider making this based off target-data, so that 32-bit targets
8254/// won't get i64 operations etc.
8255static bool isSafeIntegerType(const Type *Ty) {
8256 switch (Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
8257 case 8:
8258 case 16:
8259 case 32:
8260 case 64:
8261 return true;
8262 default:
8263 return false;
8264 }
8265}
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008266
Eli Friedmaneb7f7a82009-07-13 20:58:59 +00008267/// commonIntCastTransforms - This function implements the common transforms
8268/// for trunc, zext, and sext.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008269Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8270 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8271 return Result;
8272
8273 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8274 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8275 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008276 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8277 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008278
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008279 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
8280 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00008281 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(CI))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008282 return &CI;
8283
8284 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
8285 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008286 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
8287 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008288 return 0;
8289
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008290 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008291 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008292 // Only do this if the dest type is a simple type, don't convert the
8293 // expression tree to something weird like i93 unless the source is also
8294 // strange.
8295 if ((isSafeIntegerType(DestTy->getScalarType()) ||
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008296 !isSafeIntegerType(SrcI->getType()->getScalarType())) &&
8297 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008298 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008299 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008300 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
8301 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
8302 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
8303 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008304 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008305 bool DoXForm = false;
8306 bool JustReplace = false;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008307 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
8308 default:
8309 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
8310 // get here because of the check above.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008311 llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type");
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008312 case Instruction::Trunc:
8313 DoXForm = true;
8314 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008315 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008316 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008317 if (!DoXForm && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008318 // If it's unnecessary to issue an AND to clear the high bits, it's
8319 // always profitable to do this xform.
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008320 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, false);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008321 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8322 if (MaskedValueIsZero(TryRes, Mask))
8323 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008324
8325 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008326 if (TryI->use_empty())
8327 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
8328 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008329 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008330 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008331 case Instruction::SExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008332 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008333 if (!DoXForm && !isa<TruncInst>(SrcI) && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008334 // If we do not have to emit the truncate + sext pair, then it's always
8335 // profitable to do this xform.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008336 //
8337 // It's not safe to eliminate the trunc + sext pair if one of the
8338 // eliminated cast is a truncate. e.g.
8339 // t2 = trunc i32 t1 to i16
8340 // t3 = sext i16 t2 to i32
8341 // !=
8342 // i32 t1
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008343 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, true);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008344 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(TryRes);
8345 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
8346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008347
8348 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008349 if (TryI->use_empty())
8350 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008351 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008352 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008353 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008354 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008355
8356 if (DoXForm) {
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008357 DOUT << "ICE: EvaluateInDifferentType converting expression type to avoid"
8358 << " cast: " << CI;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008359 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8360 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008361 if (JustReplace)
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008362 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008364
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008365 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
8366 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008367 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type!");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008368 case Instruction::Trunc:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008369 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8370 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8371 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008372 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008373
8374 // If the high bits are already zero, just replace this cast with the
8375 // result.
8376 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8377 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Res, Mask))
8378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8379
8380 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008381 Constant *C = Context->getConstantInt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00008382 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008383 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008384 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008385 case Instruction::SExt: {
8386 // If the high bits are already filled with sign bit, just replace this
8387 // cast with the result.
8388 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Res);
8389 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008390 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8391
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008392 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008393 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008394 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
8395 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008396 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008397 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008398 }
8399 }
8400
8401 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
8402 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
8403
8404 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
8405 case Instruction::Add:
8406 case Instruction::Mul:
8407 case Instruction::And:
8408 case Instruction::Or:
8409 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00008410 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008411 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
8412 // Don't insert two casts unless at least one can be eliminated.
8413 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008414 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008415 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
8416 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008417 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008418 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008419 }
8420 }
8421
8422 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
8423 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
8424 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008425 Op1 == Context->getConstantIntTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008426 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00008427 Value *New = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008428 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New,
8429 Context->getConstantInt(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008430 }
8431 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008432
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008433 case Instruction::Shl: {
8434 // Canonicalize trunc inside shl, if we can.
8435 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1);
8436 if (CI && DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
8437 CI->getLimitedValue(DestBitSize) < DestBitSize) {
8438 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
8439 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008440 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008441 }
8442 break;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008443 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008444 }
8445 return 0;
8446}
8447
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008448Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008449 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8450 return Result;
8451
8452 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8453 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008454 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8455 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008456
8457 // Canonicalize trunc x to i1 -> (icmp ne (and x, 1), 0)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00008458 if (DestBitWidth == 1 &&
8459 isa<VectorType>(Ty) == isa<VectorType>(Src->getType())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008460 Constant *One = Context->getConstantInt(Src->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008461 Src = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Src, One, "tmp"), CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008462 Value *Zero = Context->getNullValue(Src->getType());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00008463 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Src, Zero);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008464 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008465
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008466 // Optimize trunc(lshr(), c) to pull the shift through the truncate.
8467 ConstantInt *ShAmtV = 0;
8468 Value *ShiftOp = 0;
8469 if (Src->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00008470 match(Src, m_LShr(m_Value(ShiftOp), m_ConstantInt(ShAmtV)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008471 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
8472
8473 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
8474 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
8475 if (MaskedValueIsZero(ShiftOp, Mask)) {
8476 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008477 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Context->getNullValue(Ty));
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008478
8479 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8480 // shift.
8481 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, ShiftOp, Ty, CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008482 Value *V2 = Context->getConstantExprTrunc(ShAmtV, Ty);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008483 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008484 }
8485 }
8486
8487 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008488}
8489
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008490/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8491/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8492Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8493 bool DoXform) {
8494 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8495 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8496 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8497 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8498 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8499
8500 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8501 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8502 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8503 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8504 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8505
8506 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008507 Value *Sh = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008508 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008509 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008510 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8511 CI);
8512 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008513 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008514 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
8515
8516 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008517 Constant *One = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008518 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008519 In->getName()+".not"),
8520 CI);
8521 }
8522
8523 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8524 }
8525
8526
8527
8528 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8529 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8530 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8531 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8532 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8533 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8534 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8535 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8536 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8537 // This only works for EQ and NE
8538 ICI->isEquality()) {
8539 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8540 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8541 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8542 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8543 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8544
8545 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8546 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8547 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8548
8549 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8550 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8551 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8552 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008553 Constant *Res = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
8554 Res = Context->getConstantExprZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008555 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8556 }
8557
8558 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8559 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8560 if (ShiftAmt) {
8561 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8562 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008563 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008564 Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008565 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
8566 }
8567
8568 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008569 Constant *One = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008570 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008571 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
8572 }
8573
8574 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8575 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8576 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008577 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008578 }
8579 }
8580 }
8581
8582 return 0;
8583}
8584
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008585Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008586 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8587 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8588 return Result;
8589
8590 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8591
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008592 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8593 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8594 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8595 if (TruncInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8596 // Get the sizes of the types involved. We know that the intermediate type
8597 // will be smaller than A or C, but don't know the relation between A and C.
8598 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008599 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8600 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8601 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008602 // If we're actually extending zero bits, then if
8603 // SrcSize < DstSize: zext(a & mask)
8604 // SrcSize == DstSize: a & mask
8605 // SrcSize > DstSize: trunc(a) & mask
8606 if (SrcSize < DstSize) {
8607 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008608 Constant *AndConst = Context->getConstantInt(A->getType(), AndValue);
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008609 Instruction *And =
8610 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, AndConst, CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8611 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
8612 return new ZExtInst(And, CI.getType());
8613 } else if (SrcSize == DstSize) {
8614 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008615 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Context->getConstantInt(A->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008616 AndValue));
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008617 } else if (SrcSize > DstSize) {
8618 Instruction *Trunc = new TruncInst(A, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8619 InsertNewInstBefore(Trunc, CI);
8620 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DstSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008621 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Trunc,
8622 Context->getConstantInt(Trunc->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008623 AndValue));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008624 }
8625 }
8626
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008627 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8628 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008629
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008630 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8631 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8632 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8633 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8634 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8635 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8636 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8637 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8638 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8639 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8640 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008641 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008642 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008643 }
8644
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008645 // zext(trunc(t) & C) -> (t & zext(C)).
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008646 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8647 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8648 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0))) {
8649 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008650 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType())
8651 return
8652 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008653 Context->getConstantExprZExt(C, CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008654 }
8655
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008656 // zext((trunc(t) & C) ^ C) -> ((t & zext(C)) ^ zext(C)).
8657 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8658 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8659 if (BinaryOperator *And = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI->getOperand(0)))
8660 if (And->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && And->hasOneUse() &&
8661 And->getOperand(1) == C)
8662 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(And->getOperand(0))) {
8663 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
8664 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008665 Constant *ZC = Context->getConstantExprZExt(C, CI.getType());
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008666 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0, ZC, "tmp");
8667 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, *And);
8668 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, ZC);
8669 }
8670 }
8671
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008672 return 0;
8673}
8674
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008675Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008676 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8677 return I;
8678
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008679 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8680
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008681 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8682 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8683 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00008684 Context->getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008685 Context->getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008686
8687 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8688 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00008689 if (Operator::getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008690 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008691 unsigned OpBits = Op->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8692 unsigned MidBits = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8693 unsigned DestBits = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008694 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8695
8696 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8697 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8698 // bits, it is already ready.
8699 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8700 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8701 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8702 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8703 // bits, just sext from i32.
8704 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8705 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8706 } else {
8707 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8708 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8709 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8710 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8711 }
8712 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008713
8714 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8715 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8716 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8717 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8718 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8719 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8720 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8721 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8722 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8723 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8724 // into:
8725 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8726 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8727 Value *A = 0;
8728 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8729 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00008730 m_ConstantInt(CA)), *Context) &&
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008731 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8732 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8733 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008734 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8735 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008736 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008737 Constant *ShAmtV = Context->getConstantInt(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008738 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8739 CI.getName()), CI);
8740 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8741 }
8742 }
8743
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008744 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008745}
8746
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008747/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8748/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008749static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008750 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008751 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008752 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008753 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8754 if (!losesInfo)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008755 return Context->getConstantFP(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008756 return 0;
8757}
8758
8759/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8760/// through it until we get the source value.
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008761static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008762 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8763 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008764 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008765
8766 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8767 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8768 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8769 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8770 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8771 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8772 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008773 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008774 return V;
8775 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8776 return V; // Won't shrink.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008777 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008778 return V;
8779 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8780 }
8781
8782 return V;
8783}
8784
8785Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8786 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8787 return I;
8788
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008789 // If we have fptrunc(fadd (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008790 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008791 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to fadd/fsub/fmul/fdiv as well as
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008792 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8793 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8794 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8795 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8796 default: break;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008797 case Instruction::FAdd:
8798 case Instruction::FSub:
8799 case Instruction::FMul:
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008800 case Instruction::FDiv:
8801 case Instruction::FRem:
8802 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008803 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0), Context);
8804 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008805 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8806 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008807 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008808 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8809 // the cast, do this xform.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008810 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8811 RHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008812 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8813 CI.getType(), CI);
8814 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8815 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008816 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008817 }
8818 }
8819 break;
8820 }
8821 }
8822 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008823}
8824
8825Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8826 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8827}
8828
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008829Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008830 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8831 if (OpI == 0)
8832 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8833
8834 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8835 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8836 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8837 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8838 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8839 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8840 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8841 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008842 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008843 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008845
8846 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008847}
8848
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008849Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008850 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8851 if (OpI == 0)
8852 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8853
8854 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8855 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8856 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8857 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8858 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8859 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8860 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8861 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008862 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008863 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008865
8866 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008867}
8868
8869Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8870 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8871}
8872
8873Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8874 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8875}
8876
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008877Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI) {
8878 // If the destination integer type is smaller than the intptr_t type for
8879 // this target, do a ptrtoint to intptr_t then do a trunc. This allows the
8880 // trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for extending
8881 // ptrtoint's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero extends its
8882 // pointers.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008883 if (CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008884 Value *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new PtrToIntInst(CI.getOperand(0),
8885 TD->getIntPtrType(),
8886 "tmp"), CI);
8887 return new TruncInst(P, CI.getType());
8888 }
8889
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008890 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008891}
8892
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008893Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008894 // If the source integer type is larger than the intptr_t type for
8895 // this target, do a trunc to the intptr_t type, then inttoptr of it. This
8896 // allows the trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for
8897 // extending inttoptr's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero
8898 // extends to pointers.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008899 if (CI.getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() >
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008900 TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8901 Value *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new TruncInst(CI.getOperand(0),
8902 TD->getIntPtrType(),
8903 "tmp"), CI);
8904 return new IntToPtrInst(P, CI.getType());
8905 }
8906
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008907 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8908 return I;
8909
8910 const Type *DestPointee = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType())->getElementType();
8911 if (!DestPointee->isSized()) return 0;
8912
8913 // If this is inttoptr(add (ptrtoint x), cst), try to turn this into a GEP.
8914 ConstantInt *Cst;
8915 Value *X;
8916 if (match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Cast<PtrToIntInst>(m_Value(X)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00008917 m_ConstantInt(Cst)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008918 // If the source and destination operands have the same type, see if this
8919 // is a single-index GEP.
8920 if (X->getType() == CI.getType()) {
8921 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008922 uint64_t Size = TD->getTypeAllocSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008923
8924 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8925 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8926 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8927
8928 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8929 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8930 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
Dan Gohman3a7a68c2009-07-17 22:25:10 +00008931 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
8932 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Context->getConstantInt(Offset));
8933 // A gep synthesized from inttoptr+add+ptrtoint must be assumed to
8934 // potentially overflow, in the absense of further analysis.
8935 cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->setHasNoPointerOverflow(false);
8936 return GEP;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008937 }
8938 }
8939 // TODO: Could handle other cases, e.g. where add is indexing into field of
8940 // struct etc.
8941 } else if (CI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00008942 match(CI.getOperand(0), m_Add(m_Value(X),
8943 m_ConstantInt(Cst)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008944 // Otherwise, if this is inttoptr(add x, cst), try to turn this into an
8945 // "inttoptr+GEP" instead of "add+intptr".
8946
8947 // Get the size of the pointee type.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008948 uint64_t Size = TD->getTypeAllocSize(DestPointee);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008949
8950 // Convert the constant to intptr type.
8951 APInt Offset = Cst->getValue();
8952 Offset.sextOrTrunc(TD->getPointerSizeInBits());
8953
8954 // If Offset is evenly divisible by Size, we can do this xform.
8955 if (Size && !APIntOps::srem(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size))){
8956 Offset = APIntOps::sdiv(Offset, APInt(Offset.getBitWidth(), Size));
8957
8958 Instruction *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new IntToPtrInst(X, CI.getType(),
8959 "tmp"), CI);
Dan Gohman3a7a68c2009-07-17 22:25:10 +00008960 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
8961 GetElementPtrInst::Create(P, Context->getConstantInt(Offset), "tmp");
8962 // A gep synthesized from inttoptr+add+ptrtoint must be assumed to
8963 // potentially overflow, in the absense of further analysis.
8964 cast<GEPOperator>(GEP)->setHasNoPointerOverflow(false);
8965 return GEP;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008966 }
8967 }
8968 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008969}
8970
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008971Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008972 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8973 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8974 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8975 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8976 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8977
Eli Friedman7e25d452009-07-13 20:53:00 +00008978 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008979 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8980 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008981 } else {
8982 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8983 return Result;
8984 }
8985
8986
8987 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8988 // be replaced by the operand.
8989 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8990 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8991
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008992 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008993 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8994 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8995 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8996
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008997 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8998 // required for changing types.
8999 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
9000 return 0;
9001
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009002 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
9003 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
9004 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
9005 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
9006 return V;
9007
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00009008 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
9009 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009010 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009011 Constant *ZeroUInt = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009012 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
9013 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
9014 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
9015 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
9016 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
9017 ++NumZeros;
9018 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00009019
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00009020 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
9021 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
9022 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009023 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
9024 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00009025 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009026 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00009027
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009028 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
9029 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
9030 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
9031 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009032 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00009033 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
9034 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
9035 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
9036 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009037 CastInst *Tmp;
9038 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
9039 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
9040 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
9041 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
9042 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
9043 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
9044 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00009045 Value *LHS = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
9046 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, CI);
9047 Value *RHS = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
9048 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009049 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
9050 // know the vector types match #elts.
9051 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00009052 }
9053 }
9054 }
9055 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009056 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009057}
9058
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009059/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
9060/// %C = or %A, %B
9061/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
9062/// into:
9063/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
9064/// %D = or %A, %C
9065///
9066/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
9067/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
9068/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
9069///
9070static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
9071 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
9072 case Instruction::Add:
9073 case Instruction::Mul:
9074 case Instruction::And:
9075 case Instruction::Or:
9076 case Instruction::Xor:
9077 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
9078 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
9079 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00009080 case Instruction::LShr:
9081 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009082 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009083 default:
9084 return 0; // Cannot fold
9085 }
9086}
9087
9088/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
9089/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009090static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00009091 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009092 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009093 default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009094 case Instruction::Add:
9095 case Instruction::Sub:
9096 case Instruction::Or:
9097 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009098 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00009099 case Instruction::LShr:
9100 case Instruction::AShr:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009101 return Context->getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009102 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009103 return Context->getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009104 case Instruction::Mul:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009105 return Context->getConstantInt(I->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009106 }
9107}
9108
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009109/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
9110/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
9111Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
9112 Instruction *FI) {
9113 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
9114 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
9115 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009116 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009117 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
9118 return 0;
9119 } else {
9120 return 0; // unknown unary op.
9121 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009122
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009123 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009124 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
9125 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009126 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009127 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009128 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009129 }
9130
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009131 // Only handle binary operators here.
9132 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009133 return 0;
9134
9135 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
9136 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
9137 bool MatchIsOpZero;
9138 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9139 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9140 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9141 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9142 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9143 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9144 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9145 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9146 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9147 MatchIsOpZero = false;
9148 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
9149 return 0;
9150 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9151 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9152 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9153 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9154 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9155 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9156 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9157 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9158 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9159 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9160 } else {
9161 return 0;
9162 }
9163
9164 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009165 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
9166 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009167 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
9168
9169 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
9170 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009171 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009172 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009173 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009174 }
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009175 llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00009176 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009177}
9178
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009179static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
9180 ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
9181 if (!C1I)
9182 return false;
9183 ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
9184 if (!C2I)
9185 return false;
9186 return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
9187}
9188
9189/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
9190/// facilitate further optimization.
9191Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
9192 Value *FalseVal) {
9193 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9194 // transformation we are doing here.
9195 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
9196 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9197 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
9198 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9199 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9200 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9201 OpToFold = 1;
9202 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9203 OpToFold = 2;
9204 }
9205
9206 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009207 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009208 Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9209 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9210 // between 0 and 1.
9211 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9212 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
9213 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9214 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
9215 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
9216 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009217 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009218 }
9219 }
9220 }
9221 }
9222 }
9223
9224 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
9225 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9226 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
9227 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9228 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9229 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9230 OpToFold = 1;
9231 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9232 OpToFold = 2;
9233 }
9234
9235 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009236 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009237 Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9238 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9239 // between 0 and 1.
9240 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9241 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
9242 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9243 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
9244 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
9245 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009246 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009247 }
9248 }
9249 }
9250 }
9251 }
9252
9253 return 0;
9254}
9255
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009256/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
9257/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
9258///
9259Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
9260 ICmpInst *ICI) {
9261 bool Changed = false;
9262 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
9263 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
9264 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
9265 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9266 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9267
9268 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
9269 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
9270 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
9271 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009272 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009273 switch (Pred) {
9274 default: break;
9275 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9276 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
9277 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
9278 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
9279 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9280 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009281 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI, Context);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009282 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9283 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9284 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9285 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9286 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9287 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9288 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9289 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9290 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9291 Changed = true;
9292 }
9293 break;
9294 }
9295 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9296 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
9297 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
9298 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
9299 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9300 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009301 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI, Context);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009302 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9303 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9304 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9305 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9306 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9307 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9308 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9309 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9310 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9311 Changed = true;
9312 }
9313 break;
9314 }
9315 }
9316
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009317 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
9318 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009319 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00009320 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>(), *Context) &&
9321 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>(), *Context))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009322 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00009323 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>(), *Context) &&
9324 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>(), *Context))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009325 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
9326
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009327 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
9328 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
9329 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
9330 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
9331 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
9332
9333 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
9334 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
9335 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009336 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009337 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009338 Value *Sh = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009339 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009340 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
9341 In->getName()+".lobit"),
9342 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00009343 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
9344 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009345 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
9346
9347 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009348 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, In,
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009349 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
9350
9351 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
9352 }
9353 }
9354 }
9355
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009356 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
9357 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
9358 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9359 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9360 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
9361 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9362 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9363 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9364
9365 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
9366 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
9367 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9369 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
9370 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9371 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9372 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9373 }
9374
9375 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
9376
9377 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
9378}
9379
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009380Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009381 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
9382 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9383 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9384
9385 // select true, X, Y -> X
9386 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009387 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009388 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009389
9390 // select C, X, X -> X
9391 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
9392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9393
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009394 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
9395 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9396 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
9397 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9398 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
9399 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9400 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9401 else
9402 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9403 }
9404
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00009405 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009406 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009407 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009408 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009409 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009410 } else {
9411 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
9412 Value *NotCond =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009413 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009414 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009415 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009416 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009417 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009418 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009419 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009420 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009421 } else {
9422 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
9423 Value *NotCond =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009424 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009425 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009426 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009427 }
9428 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009429
9430 // select a, b, a -> a&b
9431 // select a, a, b -> a|b
9432 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009433 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009434 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009435 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009436 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009437
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009438 // Selecting between two integer constants?
9439 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
9440 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009441 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009442 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009443 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009444 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009445 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009446 Value *NotCond =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009447 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009448 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009449 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009450 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009451
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009452 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009453 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009454 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009455 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
9456 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009457 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00009458 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009459 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
9460 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
9461 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009462 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
9463 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
9464 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009465 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
9466 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009467 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
9468 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009469 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009470 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009471 Value *V = ICA;
9472 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009473 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009474 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
9475 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
9476 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009477 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009478 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009479
9480 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009481 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
9482 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009483 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009484 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9485 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9486 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9487 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9488 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9489 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9490 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9491 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9492 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009493 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009494 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009495 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009496 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009498 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009499
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009500 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009501 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009502 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9503 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9504 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9505 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9506 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9507 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9508 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9509 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9510 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
9511 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9512 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009513 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009514 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
9515 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009516 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009517 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009518 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009519 }
9520
9521 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009522 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
9523 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
9524 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009525
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009526 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9527 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9528 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009529 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
9530
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009531 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
9532 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
9533 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
9534 return IV;
9535
9536 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
9537 // even legal for FP.
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009538 if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9539 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9540 (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9541 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009542 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009543 } else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9544 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9545 (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9546 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009547 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
9548 }
9549
9550 if (AddOp) {
9551 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
9552 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
9553 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
9554 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
9555 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
9556 }
9557
9558 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009559 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
9560 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
9561 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
9562 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009563 NegVal = Context->getConstantExprNeg(C);
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009564 } else {
9565 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00009566 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, SubOp->getOperand(1),
9567 "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009568 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009569
9570 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
9571 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
9572 if (AddOp != TI)
9573 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
9574 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009575 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
9576 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009577
9578 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009579 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009580 }
9581 }
9582 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009583
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009584 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00009585 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009586 Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal);
9587 if (FoldI)
9588 return FoldI;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009589 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009590
9591 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
9592 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
9593 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
9594 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
9595 return &SI;
9596 }
9597
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009598 return 0;
9599}
9600
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009601/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
9602/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
9603/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
9604/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
9605/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
9606///
9607static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9608 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009609
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009610 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
9611 if (!U) return Align;
9612
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00009613 switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009614 default: break;
9615 case Instruction::BitCast:
9616 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
9617 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009618 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
9619 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00009620 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009621 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
9622 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009623 AllZeroOperands = false;
9624 break;
9625 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009626
9627 if (AllZeroOperands) {
9628 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009629 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009630 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009631 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009632 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009633 }
9634
9635 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
9636 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
9637 // of the global.
9638 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009639 if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9640 Align = GV->getAlignment();
9641 else {
9642 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9643 Align = PrefAlign;
9644 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009645 }
9646 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
9647 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
9648 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
9649 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009650 if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9651 Align = AI->getAlignment();
9652 else {
9653 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9654 Align = PrefAlign;
9655 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009656 }
9657 }
9658
9659 return Align;
9660}
9661
9662/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9663/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9664/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9665/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9666unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9667 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9668 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9669 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9670 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9671 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9672 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9673 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9674 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9675
9676 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9677 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9678
9679 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9680 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009681}
9682
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009683Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009684 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanbc989d42009-02-22 18:06:32 +00009685 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009686 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009687 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009688
9689 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009690 MI->setAlignment(Context->getConstantInt(MI->getAlignmentType(),
9691 MinAlign, false));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009692 return MI;
9693 }
9694
9695 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9696 // load/store.
9697 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9698 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9699
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009700 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9701 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9702 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9703 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009704 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009705 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9706
9707 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009708 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009709
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009710 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009711 Type *NewPtrTy =
9712 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Context->getIntegerType(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009713
9714 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9715 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9716 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9717 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9718 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9719 // integer datatype.
9720 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9721 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
9722 if (SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
9723 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9724 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009725 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009726 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9727 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9728 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9729 else
9730 break;
9731 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9732 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9733 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9734 else
9735 break;
9736 } else
9737 break;
9738 }
9739
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009740 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009741 NewPtrTy = Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(SrcETy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009742 }
9743 }
9744
9745
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009746 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9747 // infer, use it.
9748 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9749 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9750
9751 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9752 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009753 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9754 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9755 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9756
9757 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009758 MI->setOperand(3, Context->getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009759 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009760}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009761
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009762Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9763 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009764 if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009765 MI->setAlignment(Context->getConstantInt(MI->getAlignmentType(),
9766 Alignment, false));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009767 return MI;
9768 }
9769
9770 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9771 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9772 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9773 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9774 return 0;
9775 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009776 Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009777
9778 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9779 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9780
9781 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9782 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009783 const Type *ITy = Context->getIntegerType(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009784
9785 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009786 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(ITy), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009787
9788 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9789 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9790
9791 // Extract the fill value and store.
9792 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009793 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(Context->getConstantInt(ITy, Fill),
9794 Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009795
9796 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009797 MI->setLength(Context->getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009798 return MI;
9799 }
9800
9801 return 0;
9802}
9803
9804
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009805/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9806/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9807/// the heavy lifting.
9808///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009809Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattneraab6ec42009-05-13 17:39:14 +00009810 // If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
9811 // callee isn't.
9812 if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
9813 !CI.doesNotThrow()) {
9814 CI.setDoesNotThrow();
9815 return &CI;
9816 }
9817
9818
9819
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009820 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9821 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9822
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009823 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9824 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009825 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009826 bool Changed = false;
9827
9828 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9829 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9830 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9831
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009832 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009833 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009834 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9835 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9836 // alignment is sufficient.
9837 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009838 }
9839
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009840 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9841 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9842 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009843 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009844 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9845 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9846 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00009847 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
9848 const Type *Tys[1];
9849 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
9850 CI.setOperand(0,
9851 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009852 Changed = true;
9853 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009854
9855 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9856 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9857 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009858 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009859
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009860 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9861 // set, update the alignment.
Chris Lattner3ce5e882009-03-08 03:37:16 +00009862 if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009863 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9864 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009865 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9866 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9867 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009868 }
9869
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009870 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009871 }
9872
9873 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9874 default: break;
9875 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9876 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9877 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9878 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9879 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9880 break;
9881 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9882 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9883 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9884 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9885 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9886 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9887 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9888 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9889 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009890 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(II->getType()),
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009891 CI);
9892 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009893 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009894 break;
9895 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9896 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9897 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9898 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9899 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009900 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009901 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9902 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9903 }
9904 break;
9905 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9906 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9907 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009908 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9909 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9910 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009911 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009912 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9913 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9914 }
9915 break;
9916
9917 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9918 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9919 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00009920 unsigned VWidth =
9921 cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
9922 APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
9923 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
9924 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009925 UndefElts)) {
9926 II->setOperand(1, V);
9927 return II;
9928 }
9929 break;
9930 }
9931
9932 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9933 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9934 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9935 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009936
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009937 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9938 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9939 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9940 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9941 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9942 AllEltsOk = false;
9943 break;
9944 }
9945 }
9946
9947 if (AllEltsOk) {
9948 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9949 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9950 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009951 Value *Result = Context->getUndef(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009952
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009953 // Only extract each element once.
9954 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9955 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9956
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009957 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009958 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9959 continue;
9960 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9961 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9962
9963 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9964 Instruction *Elt =
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00009965 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
9966 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Idx&15, false), "tmp");
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009967 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9968 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009969 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009970
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009971 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9972 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00009973 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i, false),
9974 "tmp");
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009975 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009976 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009977 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009978 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009979 }
9980 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009981
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009982 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9983 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9984 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9985 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9986 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9987 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9988 if (&*++BI == II)
9989 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009990 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009991 }
9992
9993 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9994 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9995 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9996 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9997 bool CannotRemove = false;
9998 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9999 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
10000 CannotRemove = true;
10001 break;
10002 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +000010003 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
10004 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
10005 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
10006 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
10007 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
10008 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
10009 } else {
10010 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
10011 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +000010012 CannotRemove = true;
10013 break;
10014 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010015 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +000010016 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010017
10018 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
10019 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
10020 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
10021 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
10022 break;
10023 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010024 }
10025
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010026 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010027}
10028
10029// InvokeInst simplification
10030//
10031Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010032 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010033}
10034
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +000010035/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
10036/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010037static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
10038 const CastInst * const CI,
10039 const TargetData * const TD,
10040 const int ix) {
10041 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
10042 return false;
10043
10044 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
10045 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
10046 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010047 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010048 return true;
10049
10050 const Type* SrcTy =
10051 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
10052 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10053 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
10054 return false;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000010055 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010056 return false;
10057 return true;
10058}
10059
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010060// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
10061//
10062Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010063 bool Changed = false;
10064
10065 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
10066 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010067 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
10068
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010069 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010070
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010071 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
10072 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
10073 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
10074 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
10075 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010076 new StoreInst(Context->getConstantIntTrue(),
10077 Context->getUndef(Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
10078 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010079 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010080 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(OldCall->getType()));
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010081 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
10082 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
10083 return 0;
10084 }
10085
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010086 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
10087 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
10088 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
10089 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010090 new StoreInst(Context->getConstantIntTrue(),
10091 Context->getUndef(Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010092 CS.getInstruction());
10093
10094 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
10095 CS.getInstruction()->
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010096 replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010097
10098 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
10099 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010100 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010101 Context->getConstantIntTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010102 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010103 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
10104 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010105
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010106 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
10107 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
10108 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
10109 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
10110
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010111 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10112 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
10113 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +000010114 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010115 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
10116 // the call.
10117 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010118 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
10119 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
10120 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
10121 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
10122 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010123 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010124 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010125 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010126
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010127 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010128 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010129 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010130 Changed = true;
10131 }
10132
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010133 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010134}
10135
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010136// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
10137// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
10138//
10139bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
10140 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
10141 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010142 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
10143 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010144 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +000010145 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010146 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010147 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010148
10149 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
10150 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
10151 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
10152 //
10153 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
10154 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010155 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010156
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010157 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +000010158 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
10159
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010160 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010161 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000010162 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010163 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
10164 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
10165 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
Duncan Sands34b176a2008-06-17 15:55:30 +000010166 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010167 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010168
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010169 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010170 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010171 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010172 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
10173
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010174 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010175 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010176 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +000010177 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
10178 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010179
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010180 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
10181 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
10182 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
10183 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
10184 if (!Caller->use_empty())
10185 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
10186 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
10187 UI != E; ++UI)
10188 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
10189 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +000010190 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010191 return false;
10192 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010193
10194 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
10195 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010196
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010197 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
10198 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
10199 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +000010200 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010201
10202 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010203 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
10204
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010205 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
10206 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010207 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010208
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010209 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
10210 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010211 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010212 ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
10213 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType()));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010214 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010215 }
10216
10217 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010218 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010219 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010220
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010221 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
10222 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010223 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010224 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
10225 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010226 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
10227 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010228 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +000010229 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010230 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010231 return false;
10232 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010233
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010234 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
10235 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
10236 std::vector<Value*> Args;
10237 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010238 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010239 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
10240
10241 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010242 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010243
10244 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
10245 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010246 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010247
10248 // Add the new return attributes.
10249 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010250 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010251
10252 AI = CS.arg_begin();
10253 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10254 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
10255 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
10256 Args.push_back(*AI);
10257 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +000010258 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010259 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010260 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010261 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010262 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010263
10264 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010265 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010266 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010267 }
10268
10269 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
10270 // now...
10271 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010272 Args.push_back(Context->getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010273
10274 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010275 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010276 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +000010277 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
10278 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010279 } else {
10280 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
10281 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10282 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
10283 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
10284 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010285 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
10286 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010287 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010288 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
10289 Args.push_back(Cast);
10290 } else {
10291 Args.push_back(*AI);
10292 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010293
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010294 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010295 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010296 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010297 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010298 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010299 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010300
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010301 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
10302 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
10303
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010304 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010305 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010306
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010307 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010308
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010309 Instruction *NC;
10310 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010311 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010312 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10313 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +000010314 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010315 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010316 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010317 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10318 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010319 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
10320 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +000010321 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010322 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010323 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010324 }
10325
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010326 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010327 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010328 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010329 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010330 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010331 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010332 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010333
10334 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
10335 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
10336 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010337 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010338 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
10339 } else {
10340 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
10341 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
10342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010343 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010344 } else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010345 NV = Context->getUndef(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010346 }
10347 }
10348
10349 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
10350 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +000010351 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010352 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010353 return true;
10354}
10355
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010356// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
10357// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
10358//
10359Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
10360 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
10361 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10362 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010363 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010364
10365 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
10366 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010367 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010368 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010369
10370 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
10371 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
10372
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +000010373 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010374 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
10375 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
10376
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010377 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010378 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010379 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
10380 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010381 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010382
10383 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
10384 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
10385 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010386 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010387 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
10388 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010389 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010390 break;
10391 }
10392
10393 if (NestTy) {
10394 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
10395 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
10396 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
10397
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010398 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010399 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010400
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010401 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010402 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
10403
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010404 // Add any result attributes.
10405 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010406 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010407
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010408 {
10409 unsigned Idx = 1;
10410 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
10411 do {
10412 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010413 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010414 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
10415 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
10416 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
10417 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010418 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010419 }
10420
10421 if (I == E)
10422 break;
10423
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010424 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010425 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010426 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010427 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010428 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010429
10430 ++Idx, ++I;
10431 } while (1);
10432 }
10433
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010434 // Add any function attributes.
10435 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
10436 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
10437
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010438 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
10439 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010440 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010441
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010442 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010443 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
10444
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010445 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010446 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010447 {
10448 unsigned Idx = 1;
10449 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
10450 E = FTy->param_end();
10451
10452 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010453 if (Idx == NestIdx)
10454 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010455 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010456
10457 if (I == E)
10458 break;
10459
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010460 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010461 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010462
10463 ++Idx, ++I;
10464 } while (1);
10465 }
10466
10467 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
10468 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10469 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010470 Context->getFunctionType(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
10471 FTy->isVarArg());
10472 Constant *NewCallee =
10473 NestF->getType() == Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(NewFTy) ?
10474 NestF : Context->getConstantExprBitCast(NestF,
10475 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010476 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010477
10478 Instruction *NewCaller;
10479 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010480 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
10481 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
10482 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10483 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010484 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010485 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010486 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010487 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10488 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010489 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
10490 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
10491 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
10492 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010493 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010494 }
10495 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
10496 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
10497 Caller->eraseFromParent();
10498 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
10499 return 0;
10500 }
10501 }
10502
10503 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
10504 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
10505 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10506 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010507 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
10508 Context->getConstantExprBitCast(NestF, PTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010509 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
10510 return CS.getInstruction();
10511}
10512
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010513/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
10514/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
10515/// and a single binop.
10516Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10517 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010518 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010519 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010520 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10521 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
10522
10523 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
10524 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010525
10526 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
10527 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010528 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010529 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +000010530 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010531 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010532 // types or GEP's with different index types.
10533 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
10534 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010535 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010536
10537 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
10538 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
10539 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
10540 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
10541 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010542
10543 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
10544 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
10545 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010546 }
10547
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010548 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010549
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010550 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010551 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010552 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010553 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010554 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
10555 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010556 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10557 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010558 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
10559 LHSVal = NewLHS;
10560 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010561
10562 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010563 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
10564 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010565 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10566 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010567 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
10568 RHSVal = NewRHS;
10569 }
10570
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010571 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010572 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
10573 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10574 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10575 if (NewLHS) {
10576 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
10577 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10578 }
10579 if (NewRHS) {
10580 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
10581 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10582 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010583 }
10584 }
10585
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010586 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010587 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010588 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010589 return CmpInst::Create(*Context, CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
10590 LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010591}
10592
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010593Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10594 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10595
10596 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
10597 FirstInst->op_end());
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010598 // This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
10599 // constants.
10600 bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010601
10602 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
10603 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
10604 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
10605 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10606 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
10607 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
10608 return 0;
10609
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010610 // Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
10611 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
10612 (!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
10613 !GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
10614 AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
10615
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010616 // Compare the operand lists.
10617 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
10618 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
10619 continue;
10620
10621 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
10622 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
10623 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
10624 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
10625 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
10626 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
10627 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
10628 return 0;
10629
10630 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
10631 return 0;
10632 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
10633 }
10634 }
10635
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010636 // If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010637 // bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010638 // offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
10639 // stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
10640 // load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
10641 // which can usually all be folded into the load.
10642 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
10643 return 0;
10644
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010645 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
10646 // that is variable.
10647 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
10648
10649 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
10650 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10651 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
10652 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
10653 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
10654 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
10655 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10656
10657 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
10658 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10659 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
10660 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
10661 HasAnyPHIs = true;
10662 }
10663
10664
10665 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
10666 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
10667 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10668 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10669 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
10670
10671 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
10672 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
10673 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
10674 }
10675 }
10676
10677 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
10678 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10679 FixedOperands.end());
10680}
10681
10682
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010683/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
10684/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010685/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
10686/// the end of the block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010687///
10688/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
10689/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
10690/// to a register.
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010691static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010692 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
10693
10694 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
10695 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10696 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010697
10698 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
10699 // profitable to do this xform.
10700 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
10701 bool isAddressTaken = false;
10702 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
10703 UI != E; ++UI) {
10704 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
10705 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
10706 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
10707 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
10708 }
10709 isAddressTaken = true;
10710 break;
10711 }
10712
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010713 if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010714 return false;
10715 }
10716
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010717 // If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
10718 // then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
10719 // load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
10720 // materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
10721 // do a shared load from register in the successor.
10722 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
10723 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
10724 if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
10725 return false;
10726
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010727 return true;
10728}
10729
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010730
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010731// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
10732// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
10733// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
10734Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10735 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10736
10737 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
10738 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
10739 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
10740 // code size and simplifying code.
10741 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
10742 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010743 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010744 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
10745 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000010746 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010747 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
10748 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010749 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010750 if (ConstantOp == 0)
10751 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010752 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
10753 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
10754 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
10755 // load and the PHI.
10756 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010757 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010758 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010759
10760 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10761 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10762 // the path through the other successor.
10763 if (isVolatile &&
10764 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10765 return 0;
10766
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010767 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010768 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010769 } else {
10770 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10771 }
10772
10773 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10774 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10775 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10776 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010777 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010778 return 0;
10779 if (CastSrcTy) {
10780 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10781 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010782 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010783 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10784 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010785 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10786 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010787 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010788 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010789
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010790 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10791 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10792 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010793 if (isVolatile &&
10794 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10795 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010796
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010797 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10798 return 0;
10799 }
10800 }
10801
10802 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10803 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010804 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10805 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010806 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010807
10808 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10809 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010810
10811 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010812 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10813 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10814 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10815 InVal = 0;
10816 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10817 }
10818
10819 Value *PhiVal;
10820 if (InVal) {
10821 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10822 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10823 PhiVal = InVal;
10824 delete NewPN;
10825 } else {
10826 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10827 PhiVal = NewPN;
10828 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010829
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010830 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010831 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010832 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010833 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010834 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010835 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010836 return CmpInst::Create(*Context, CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010837 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010838 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10839
10840 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10841 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10842 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10843 if (isVolatile)
10844 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10845 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10846
10847 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010848}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010849
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010850/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10851/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010852static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10853 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010854 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10855 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10856
10857 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010858 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010859 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010860
10861 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10862 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10863 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010864
10865 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10866 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010867
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010868 return false;
10869}
10870
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010871/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10872/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10873/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10874static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10875 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10876 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10877 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10878 return true;
10879
10880 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10881 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10882 return false;
10883
10884 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10885 // the value.
10886 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10887 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10888 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10889 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10890 return false;
10891 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10892 return false;
10893 }
10894
10895 return true;
10896}
10897
10898
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010899// PHINode simplification
10900//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010901Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010902 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010903 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010904
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010905 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10906 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10907
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010908 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10909 // reducing code size.
10910 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010911 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
10912 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
10913 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
10914 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
10915 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010916 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10917 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10918 return Result;
10919
10920 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10921 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10922 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010923 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10924 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10925 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010926 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010927 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10928 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010929 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, Context->getUndef(PN.getType()));
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010930 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010931
10932 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10933 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10934 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10935 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10936 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10937 // late.
10938 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10939 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10940 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010941 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, Context->getUndef(PN.getType()));
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010942 }
10943 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010944
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010945 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10946 // same value, for example:
10947 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10948 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10949 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10950 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10951 {
10952 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10953 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10954 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10955 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10956 ++InValNo;
10957
10958 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10959 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10960
10961 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10962 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10963 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10964 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10965 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10966 break;
10967 }
10968
10969 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10970 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10971 // the value.
10972 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10973 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10974 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10975 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10976 }
10977 }
10978 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010979 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010980}
10981
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010982static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10983 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10984 InstCombiner *IC) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000010985 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
10986 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010987 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10988 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10989 // used for address computation.
10990 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10991 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10992 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10993 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010994}
10995
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010996
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010997Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010998 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010999 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000011000 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011001 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011002 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011003
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011004 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011005 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, Context->getUndef(GEP.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011006
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011007 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
11008 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
11009 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
11010
11011 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011012 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000011013
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011014 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
11015 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000011016
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011017 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011018 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
11019 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Sanjiv Gupta7787d4a2009-04-24 02:37:54 +000011020 if (isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011021 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000011022 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
11023 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
11024 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
11025 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
11026 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011027 if (SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000011028 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011029 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011030 }
11031 }
11032 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011033 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000011034 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
11035 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011036 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
11037 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011038 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011039 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000011040 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011041 *i = Context->getConstantExprTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000011042 MadeChange = true;
11043 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011044 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
11045 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011046 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011047 MadeChange = true;
11048 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000011049 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
11050 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011051 *i = Context->getConstantExprSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000011052 MadeChange = true;
11053 } else {
11054 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
11055 GEP);
11056 *i = Op;
11057 MadeChange = true;
11058 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011059 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011060 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000011061 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011062 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
11063
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011064 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
11065 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
11066 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
11067 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011068 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000011069 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011070 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000011071
11072 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011073 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
11074 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
11075 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
11076 //
11077 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
11078 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
11079 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
11080
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011081 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011082
11083 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
11084 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
11085 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
11086 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000011087 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011088
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011089 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011090 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000011091 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
11092 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
11093 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011094 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011095 if (SO1 == Context->getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011096 Sum = GO1;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011097 } else if (GO1 == Context->getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011098 Sum = SO1;
11099 } else {
11100 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
11101 // target's pointer size.
11102 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
11103 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011104 SO1 =
11105 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011106 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011107 GO1 =
11108 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011109 } else {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000011110 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
11111 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011112 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011113 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011114
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000011115 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011116 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011117 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011118 } else {
11119 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011120 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
11121 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011122 }
11123 }
11124 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011125 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011126 Sum = Context->getConstantExprAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1),
11127 cast<Constant>(GO1));
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011128 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011129 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000011130 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011131 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011132 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011133
11134 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
11135 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
11136 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
11137 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
11138 return &GEP;
11139 } else {
11140 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
11141 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
11142 Indices.push_back(Sum);
11143 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
11144 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011145 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011146 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011147 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011148 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000011149 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
11150 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011151 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
11152 }
11153
11154 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011155 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
11156 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011157
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011158 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011159 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
11160 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
11161
11162 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011163 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011164 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
11165 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
11166 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
11167
11168 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011169 Constant *CE = Context->getConstantExprGetElementPtr(GV,
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011170 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011171
11172 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
11173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
11174 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011175 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011176 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
11177 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
11178 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011179 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11180 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011181 //
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011182 // Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11183 // into : GEP i8* X, ...
11184 //
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011185 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011186 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
11187 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011188 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
11189 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
11190 // GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
11191 if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
11192 // -> GEP i8* X, ...
11193 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
11194 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11195 GEP.getName());
11196 } else if (const ArrayType *XATy =
11197 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())) {
11198 // GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011199 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011200 // -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011201 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
11202 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
11203 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
11204 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
11205 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
11206 return &GEP;
11207 }
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011208 }
11209 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011210 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
11211 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011212 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
11213 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011214 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
11215 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
11216 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011217 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
11218 TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011219 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011220 Idx[0] = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011221 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011222 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011223 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011224 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
11225 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011226 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011227
11228 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011229 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011230 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011231 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011232
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011233 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011234 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011235 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011236
11237 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
11238 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
11239 Value *NewIdx = 0;
11240 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
11241 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
11242 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011243 Scale =
11244 Context->getConstantInt(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011245 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011246 NewIdx = Context->getConstantInt(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011247 Scale = CI;
11248 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
11249 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
11250 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000011251 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11252 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011253 Scale = Context->getConstantInt(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011254 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011255 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11256 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
11257 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
11258 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11259 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11260 }
11261 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011262
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011263 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011264 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
11265 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
11266 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
Chris Lattner58b1ac72009-02-25 18:20:01 +000011267 if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011268 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011269 Scale = Context->getConstantInt(Scale->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011270 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011271 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011272 Constant *C =
11273 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011274 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011275 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011276 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
11277 }
11278
11279 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011280 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011281 Idx[0] = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011282 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011283 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011284 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011285 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
11286 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
11287 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011288 }
11289 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011290 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011291 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011292
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011293 /// See if we can simplify:
11294 /// X = bitcast A to B*
11295 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
11296 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
11297 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011298 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011299 if (!isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
11300 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
11301 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011302 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
11303 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011304 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
11305
11306 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
11307 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
11308 if (Offset == 0) {
11309 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
11310 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
11311 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
11312 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
11313 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
11314 if (I != BCI) {
11315 I->takeName(BCI);
11316 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
11317 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
11318 }
11319 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011320 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011321 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011322 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011323 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011324
11325 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
11326 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
11327 // GEP.
11328 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
11329 const Type *InTy =
11330 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011331 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011332 Instruction *NGEP =
11333 GetElementPtrInst::Create(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11334 NewIndices.end());
11335 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType()) return NGEP;
11336 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, GEP);
11337 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
11338 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
11339 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011340 }
11341 }
11342
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011343 return 0;
11344}
11345
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011346Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
11347 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011348 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011349 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
11350 const Type *NewTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011351 Context->getArrayType(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011352 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011353
11354 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
11355 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +000011356 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011357 else {
11358 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +000011359 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011360 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011361
11362 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011363
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011364 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011365 // allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011366 //
11367 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011368 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011369
11370 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
11371 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
11372 //
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011373 Value *NullIdx = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011374 Value *Idx[2];
11375 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
11376 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011377 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
11378 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011379
11380 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
11381 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011383 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Context->getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011385 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011386 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011387
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011388 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
11389 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +000011390 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
11391 // and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011392 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011393 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Context->getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011394
11395 // If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
11396 if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
11397 AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
11398 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011399
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011400 return 0;
11401}
11402
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011403Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
11404 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
11405
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011406 // free undef -> unreachable.
11407 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
11408 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011409 new StoreInst(Context->getConstantIntTrue(),
11410 Context->getUndef(Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011411 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11412 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011413
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011414 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
11415 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011416 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011417 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011418
11419 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
11420 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
11421 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
11422 return &FI;
11423 }
11424
11425 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
11426 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11427 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
11428 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
11429 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
11430 return &FI;
11431 }
11432 }
11433
11434 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
11435 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
11436 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
11437 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11438 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
11439 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011440
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011441 return 0;
11442}
11443
11444
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011445/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011446static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011447 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011448 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011449 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011450 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011451
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011452 if (TD) {
11453 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
11454 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
11455 // directly if string length is small enough.
11456 std::string Str;
11457 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
11458 unsigned len = Str.length();
11459 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
11460 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
11461 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
11462 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
11463 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
11464 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
11465 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
11466 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
11467 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11468 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11469 }
11470 } else {
11471 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
11472 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11473 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11474 }
11475 // Append NULL at the end.
11476 SingleChar = 0;
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011477 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11478 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011479 Value *NL = Context->getConstantInt(StrVal);
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011480 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011481 }
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011482 }
11483 }
11484 }
11485
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011486 const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
11487 const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011488 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011489
11490 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
11491 if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
11492 return 0;
11493
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011494 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011495
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011496 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011497 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011498 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11499 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11500 // constants.
11501 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
11502 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
11503 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011504 Value *Idxs[2];
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011505 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
11506 CastOp = Context->getConstantExprGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011507 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11508 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11509 }
11510
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011511 if ((SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011512 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000011513 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
11514 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
11515 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011516 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
11517 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011518
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011519 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11520 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
11521 // the result of the loaded value.
11522 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
11523 CI->getName(),
11524 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
11525 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011526 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011527 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011528 }
11529 }
11530 return 0;
11531}
11532
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011533Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
11534 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000011535
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011536 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohman926b0a22009-02-16 00:44:23 +000011537 unsigned KnownAlign =
11538 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000011539 if (KnownAlign >
11540 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
11541 LI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011542 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11543
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011544 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011545 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011546 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011547 return Res;
11548
11549 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
11550 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000011551
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011552 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
11553 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
11554 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
11555 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011556 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
11557 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011558
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011559 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11560 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
11561 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
11562 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
11563 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011564 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11565 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11566 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11567 // CFG.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011568 new StoreInst(Context->getUndef(LI.getType()),
11569 Context->getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11570 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011571 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011572 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011573
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011574 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011575 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011576 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
11577 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
11578 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011579 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
11580 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
11581 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011582 new StoreInst(Context->getUndef(LI.getType()),
11583 Context->getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011585 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011586
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011587 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
11588 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011589 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011590 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011591
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011592 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011593 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011594 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
11595 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011596 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000011597 if (Constant *V =
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000011598 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE,
11599 Context))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011600 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011601 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
11602 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11603 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11604 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11605 // CFG.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011606 new StoreInst(Context->getUndef(LI.getType()),
11607 Context->getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11608 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011609 }
11610
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011611 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011612 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011613 return Res;
11614 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011615 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011616 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011617
11618 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
11619 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000011620 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011621 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer()) {
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011622 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011623 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getNullValue(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011624 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011625 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011626 }
11627 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000011628
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011629 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011630 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
11631 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
11632 // exposes redundancy in the code.
11633 //
11634 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
11635 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
11636 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
11637 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
11638 // unconditionally.
11639 //
11640 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
11641 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000011642 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
11643 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011644 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000011645 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011646 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000011647 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011648 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011649 }
11650
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000011651 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
11652 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
11653 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11654 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
11655 return &LI;
11656 }
11657
11658 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
11659 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
11660 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11661 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
11662 return &LI;
11663 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011664 }
11665 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011666 return 0;
11667}
11668
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000011669/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011670/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
11671/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011672static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
11673 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
11674 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011675 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011676
11677 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011678 const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11679 if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
11680
11681 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011682
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011683 if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
11684 return 0;
11685
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011686 /// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
11687 /// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
11688 /// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
11689 /// on 32-bit hosts.
11690 SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
11691
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011692 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11693 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11694 // constants.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011695 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
11696 // Index through pointer.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011697 Constant *Zero = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011698 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11699
11700 while (1) {
11701 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
Torok Edwin08ffee52009-01-24 17:16:04 +000011702 if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
Torok Edwin629e92b2009-01-24 11:30:49 +000011703 break;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011704 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11705 SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
11706 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
11707 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11708 SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
11709 } else {
11710 break;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011711 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011712 }
11713
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011714 SrcTy = Context->getPointerType(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011715 }
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011716
11717 if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
11718 return 0;
11719
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011720 // If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
11721 // values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
11722 if (SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
11723 cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
11724 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011725 IC.getTargetData().getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
11726 return 0;
11727
11728 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11729 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
11730 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
11731 Value *NewCast;
11732 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
11733 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
11734 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
11735 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
11736 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11737 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
11738 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
11739 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11740 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
11741 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011742 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011743
11744 // SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
11745 // emit a GEP to index into its first field.
11746 if (!NewGEPIndices.empty()) {
11747 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011748 CastOp = Context->getConstantExprGetElementPtr(C, &NewGEPIndices[0],
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011749 NewGEPIndices.size());
11750 else
11751 CastOp = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
11752 GetElementPtrInst::Create(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
11753 NewGEPIndices.end()), SI);
11754 }
11755
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011756 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011757 NewCast = Context->getConstantExprCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011758 else
11759 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
11760 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
11761 SI);
11762 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011763}
11764
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011765/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
11766/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
11767/// value in code like this:
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011768/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011769/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011770/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011771/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
11772///
11773static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
11774 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
11775 if (A == B) return true;
11776
11777 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
11778 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
11779 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
11780 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
11781 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
11782 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
11783 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
11784 return true;
11785
11786 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
11787 return false;
11788}
11789
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011790// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
11791// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
11792DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
11793 if (!V->hasNUses(2))
11794 return 0;
11795 for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
11796 UI != E; ++UI) {
11797 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
11798 return DI;
11799 if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
11800 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
11801 return DI;
11802 }
11803 }
11804 return 0;
11805}
11806
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011807Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
11808 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
11809 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
11810
11811 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011812 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011813 ++NumCombined;
11814 return 0;
11815 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011816
11817 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
11818 // alloca dead.
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011819 // If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
11820 // llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
11821 // alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
11822 // codegen.
11823 if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
11824 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
11825 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011826 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11827 ++NumCombined;
11828 return 0;
11829 }
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011830 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
11831 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11832 if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
11833 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11834 ++NumCombined;
11835 return 0;
11836 }
11837 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11838 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11839 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11840 ++NumCombined;
11841 return 0;
11842 }
11843 }
11844 }
11845 }
11846 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
11847 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11848 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11849 ++NumCombined;
11850 return 0;
11851 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011852 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011853
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011854 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohman926b0a22009-02-16 00:44:23 +000011855 unsigned KnownAlign =
11856 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +000011857 if (KnownAlign >
11858 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11859 SI.getAlignment()))
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011860 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11861
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011862 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011863 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11864 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11865 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11866 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11867 --ScanInsts) {
Dale Johannesen0d6596b2009-03-04 01:20:34 +000011868 --BBI;
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011869 // Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
11870 // and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
11871 // It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
11872 // llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
Dale Johannesen4ded40a2009-03-03 22:36:47 +000011873 if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011874 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011875 ScanInsts++;
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011876 continue;
11877 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011878
11879 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11880 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011881 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11882 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011883 ++NumDeadStore;
11884 ++BBI;
11885 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11886 continue;
11887 }
11888 break;
11889 }
11890
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011891 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11892 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11893 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11894 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011895 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11896 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011897 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11898 ++NumCombined;
11899 return 0;
11900 }
11901 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11902 // may not be dead.
11903 break;
11904 }
11905
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011906 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011907 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011908 break;
11909 }
11910
11911
11912 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011913
11914 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
Chris Lattner3590abf2009-06-11 17:54:56 +000011915 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) &&
11916 cast<PointerType>(Ptr->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011917 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011918 SI.setOperand(0, Context->getUndef(Val->getType()));
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011919 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011920 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011921 ++NumCombined;
11922 }
11923 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11924 }
11925
11926 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11927 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011928 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011929 ++NumCombined;
11930 return 0;
11931 }
11932
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011933 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11934 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011935 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011936 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11937 return Res;
11938 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011939 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011940 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11941 return Res;
11942
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011943
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011944 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
11945 // excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
11946 // into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
11947 // to move it to the successor block.
11948 BBI = &SI;
11949 do {
11950 ++BBI;
11951 } while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11952 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011953 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011954 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11955 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11956 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011957
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011958 return 0;
11959}
11960
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011961/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11962/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11963/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11964///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011965/// Simplify things like:
11966/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11967/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11968///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011969bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11970 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11971
11972 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11973 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11974 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011975 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011976
11977 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11978 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011979 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11980 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011981 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011982 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011983 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011984 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011985 return false;
11986
11987 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011988 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011989 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011990 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011991 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011992 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011993 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011994
11995 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11996 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11997 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11998 return false;
11999
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012000 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
12001 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012002 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012003 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012004 return false;
12005
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012006 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
12007 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
12008 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
12009 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012010 --BBI;
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000012011 // Skip over debugging info.
12012 while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
12013 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
12014 if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
12015 return false;
12016 --BBI;
12017 }
12018 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012019 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
12020 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
12021 return false;
12022 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000012023 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012024 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
12025 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
12026 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
12027 return false;
12028
12029 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000012030 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
12031 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012032 for (;; --BBI) {
12033 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
12034 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
12035 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
12036 return false;
12037 break;
12038 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012039 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
12040 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
12041 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012042 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
12043 return false;
12044 }
12045
12046 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012047 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
12048 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012049 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
12050 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012051 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012052 return false;
12053 }
12054 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012055
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012056 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012057 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
12058 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000012059 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012060 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
12061 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012062 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
12063 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012064 }
12065
12066 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
12067 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012068 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012069 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
12070 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
12071
12072 // Nuke the old stores.
12073 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12074 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
12075 ++NumCombined;
12076 return true;
12077}
12078
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012079
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000012080Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
12081 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000012082 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012083 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
12084 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +000012085 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest), *Context) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012086 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
12087 // Swap Destinations and condition...
12088 BI.setCondition(X);
12089 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12090 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
12091 return &BI;
12092 }
12093
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012094 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
12095 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
12096 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +000012097 TrueDest, FalseDest), *Context))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012098 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
12099 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
12100 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012101 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000012102 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(I, NewPred, X, Y, "");
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012103 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012104 // Swap Destinations and condition...
12105 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
12106 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12107 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012108 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012109 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012110 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012111 return &BI;
12112 }
12113
12114 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
12115 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
12116 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +000012117 TrueDest, FalseDest), *Context))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012118 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
12119 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
12120 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
12121 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012122 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000012123 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(I, NewPred, X, Y, "");
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012124 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012125 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012126 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012127 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12128 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012129 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012130 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012131 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012132 return &BI;
12133 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012134
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000012135 return 0;
12136}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012137
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012138Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
12139 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
12140 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
12141 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
12142 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
12143 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
12144 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012145 SI.setOperand(i,
12146 Context->getConstantExprSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012147 AddRHS));
12148 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012149 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012150 return &SI;
12151 }
12152 }
12153 return 0;
12154}
12155
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012156Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012157 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012158
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012159 if (!EV.hasIndices())
12160 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
12161
12162 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
12163 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012164 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Context->getUndef(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012165
12166 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012167 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Context->getNullValue(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012168
12169 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
12170 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
12171 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
12172 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
12173 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
12174 // first index
12175 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
12176 else
12177 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
12178 }
12179 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
12180 }
12181 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
12182 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
12183 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
12184 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
12185 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
12186 exti != exte && insi != inse;
12187 ++exti, ++insi) {
12188 if (*insi != *exti)
12189 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
12190 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
12191 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
12192 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
12193 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12194 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
12195 // with
12196 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
12197 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12198 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
12199 }
12200 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
12201 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
12202 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12203 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
12204 // with "i32 42"
12205 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
12206 if (exti == exte) {
12207 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
12208 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12209 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
12210 // with
12211 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
12212 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
12213 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
12214 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
12215 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
12216 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12217 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
12218 EV);
12219 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12220 insi, inse);
12221 }
12222 if (insi == inse)
12223 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
12224 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
12225 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
12226 // i.e., replace
12227 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12228 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
12229 // with
12230 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
12231 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12232 exti, exte);
12233 }
12234 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
12235 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
12236 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
12237 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012238 return 0;
12239}
12240
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012241/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
12242/// is to leave as a vector operation.
12243static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
12244 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
12245 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012246 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012247 if (isConstant) return true;
12248 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
12249 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
12250 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
12251 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
12252 return false;
12253 return true;
12254 }
12255 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
12256 if (!I) return false;
12257
12258 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
12259 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
12260 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
12261 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
12262 return true;
12263 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
12264 return true;
12265 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
12266 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
12267 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12268 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12269 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012270 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
12271 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
12272 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12273 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12274 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012275
12276 return false;
12277}
12278
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000012279/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
12280///
12281/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
12282/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012283static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
12284 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
12285 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12286 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
12287 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12288 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
12289
12290 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012291 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012292 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
12293 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012294 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
12295 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012296 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012297 return Result;
12298}
12299
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012300/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
12301/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
12302/// extracted from the vector.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012303static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012304 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012305 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
12306 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012307 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
12308 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012309 return Context->getUndef(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012310
12311 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012312 return Context->getUndef(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012313 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012314 return Context->getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012315 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012316 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
12317 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12318 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012319 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
12320 return 0;
12321 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012322
12323 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
12324 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012325 if (EltNo == IIElt)
12326 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012327
12328 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
12329 // vector input.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012330 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo, Context);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012331 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012332 unsigned LHSWidth =
12333 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012334 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012335 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012336 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl, Context);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012337 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012338 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth, Context);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012339 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012340 return Context->getUndef(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012341 }
12342
12343 // Otherwise, we don't know.
12344 return 0;
12345}
12346
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012347Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012348 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012349 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getUndef(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012351
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012352 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012353 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012354 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getNullValue(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012355
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012356 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000012357 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
12358 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
12359 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012360 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012361 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012362 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
12363 op0 = 0;
12364 break;
12365 }
12366 if (op0)
12367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012368 }
Eli Friedmanfc21f8f2009-07-18 09:07:47 +000012369
12370 unsigned VectorWidth =
12371 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
12372
12373 // Canonicalize extractelement from a vector of width 1 to a bitcast
12374 if (VectorWidth == 1)
12375 return new BitCastInst(EI.getOperand(0), EI.getType());
12376
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012377 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
12378 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012379 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012380 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012381
12382 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
12383 // crashing the code below.
12384 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012385 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getUndef(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012386
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012387 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
12388 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
12389 // property.
Eli Friedmanfc21f8f2009-07-18 09:07:47 +000012390 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012391 APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
12392 APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012393 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012394 DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012395 EI.setOperand(0, V);
12396 return &EI;
12397 }
12398 }
12399
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012400 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012401 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012402
12403 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
12404 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
12405 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
12406 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
12407 if (const VectorType *VT =
12408 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
12409 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012410 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0),
12411 IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012412 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
12413 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012414 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012415
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012416 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012417 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
12418 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
12419 // profitable to do so
12420 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012421 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
12422 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
12423 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
12424 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
12425 EI.getName()+".lhs");
12426 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
12427 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
12428 EI.getName()+".rhs");
12429 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
12430 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000012431 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012432 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000012433 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000012434 unsigned AS =
12435 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000012436 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012437 Context->getPointerType(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000012438 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
12439 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012440 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
12441 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012442 }
12443 }
12444 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
12445 // Extracting the inserted element?
12446 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
12447 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
12448 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
12449 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
12450 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
12451 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12452 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
12453 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
12454 return &EI;
12455 }
12456 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
12457 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
12458 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012459 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12460 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012461 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012462 unsigned LHSWidth =
12463 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
12464
12465 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012466 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012467 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
12468 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012469 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
12470 } else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012471 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getUndef(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000012472 }
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +000012473 return new ExtractElementInst(Src,
12474 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, SrcIdx, false));
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012475 }
12476 }
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012477 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012478 return 0;
12479}
12480
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012481/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
12482/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
12483/// Otherwise, return false.
12484static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012485 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012486 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012487 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
12488 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012489 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012490
12491 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012492 Mask.assign(NumElts, Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012493 return true;
12494 } else if (V == LHS) {
12495 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012496 Mask.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012497 return true;
12498 } else if (V == RHS) {
12499 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012500 Mask.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012501 return true;
12502 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12503 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12504 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12505 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12506 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12507
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012508 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
12509 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012510 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012511
12512 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
12513 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12514 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012515 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012516 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012517 Mask[InsertedIdx] = Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012518 return true;
12519 }
12520 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
12521 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012522 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12523 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012524 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012525
12526 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
12527 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
12528 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12529 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012530 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012531 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
12532 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012533 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012534 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012535 } else {
12536 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012537 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012538 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012539
12540 }
12541 return true;
12542 }
12543 }
12544 }
12545 }
12546 }
12547 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
12548
12549 return false;
12550}
12551
12552/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
12553/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
12554/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012555static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012556 Value *&RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012557 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012558 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012559 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012560 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012561
12562 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012563 Mask.assign(NumElts, Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012564 return V;
12565 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012566 Mask.assign(NumElts, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012567 return V;
12568 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12569 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12570 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12571 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12572 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12573
12574 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12575 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12576 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12577 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012578 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
12579 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012580
12581 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
12582 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012583 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
12584 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012585 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS, Context);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012586 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012587 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012588 return V;
12589 }
12590
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012591 if (VecOp == RHS) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012592 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask,
12593 RHS, Context);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012594 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
12595 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
12596 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012597 Mask[i] = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012598 }
12599 return V;
12600 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012601
12602 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
12603 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012604 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask,
12605 Context))
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012606 return EI->getOperand(0);
12607
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012608 }
12609 }
12610 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012611 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012612
12613 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
12614 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012615 Mask.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012616 return V;
12617}
12618
12619Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
12620 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
12621 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
12622 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
12623
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000012624 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
12625 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
12626 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
Eli Friedmanfc21f8f2009-07-18 09:07:47 +000012627
12628 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
12629
12630 // Canonicalize insertelement into vector of width 1 to a bitcast
12631 if (NumVectorElts == 1)
12632 return new BitCastInst(IE.getOperand(1), IE.getType());
12633
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012634 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
12635 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
12636 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12637 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12638 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000012639 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
12640 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012641 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012642
12643 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
12644 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12645
12646 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012647 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, Context->getUndef(IE.getType()));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012648
12649 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
12650 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
12651 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
12652 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12653
12654 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
12655 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
12656 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
12657 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
12658 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
12659 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
12660 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
12661 // Build a new shuffle mask.
12662 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
12663 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012664 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012665 else {
12666 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012667 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012668 NumVectorElts));
12669 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012670 Mask[InsertedIdx] =
12671 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012672 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012673 Context->getConstantVector(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012674 }
12675
12676 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
12677 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
12678 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
12679 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012680 Value *RHS = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012681 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS, Context);
12682 if (RHS == 0) RHS = Context->getUndef(LHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012683 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012684 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
12685 Context->getConstantVector(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012686 }
12687 }
12688 }
12689
Eli Friedmanb9a4cac2009-06-06 20:08:03 +000012690 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
12691 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12692 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12693 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
12694 return &IE;
12695
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012696 return 0;
12697}
12698
12699
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012700Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
12701 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12702 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012703 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012704
12705 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012706
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012707 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012708 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012709 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, Context->getUndef(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012710
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012711 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012712
12713 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
12714 return 0;
12715
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012716 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12717 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12718 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012719 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12720 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012721 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012722 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012723
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012724 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
12725 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
12726 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
12727 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012728 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
12729 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12730 }
12731
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012732 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
12733 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12734 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012735 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012736 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012737 else {
12738 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012739 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012740 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012741 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012742 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012743 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012744 Elts.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012745 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012746 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012747 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012748 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012749 SVI.setOperand(1, Context->getUndef(RHS->getType()));
12750 SVI.setOperand(2, Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012751 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12752 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012753 MadeChange = true;
12754 }
12755
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012756 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012757 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012758
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012759 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12760 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
12761 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
12762 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
12763
12764 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
12765 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012766 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012767
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012768 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
12769 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12770 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012771
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012772 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
12773 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
12774 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
12775 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
12776 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
12777 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
12778 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
12779 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
12780 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
12781 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
12782 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
12783 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
12784
12785 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
12786 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
12787 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
12788 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
12789 else
12790 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
12791
12792 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
12793 // the replacement.
12794 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012795 unsigned LHSInNElts =
12796 cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012797 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12798 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012799 if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012800 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012801 } else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012802 Elts.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012803 }
12804 }
12805 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
12806 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012807 Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012808 }
12809 }
12810 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000012811
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012812 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
12813}
12814
12815
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012816
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012817
12818/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
12819/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
12820/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
12821/// end of its block.
12822static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
12823 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
12824
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000012825 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Duncan Sands7af1c782009-05-06 06:49:50 +000012826 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000012827 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012828
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012829 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000012830 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
12831 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012832 return false;
12833
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012834 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
12835 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000012836 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
12837 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012838 Scan != E; ++Scan)
12839 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
12840 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012841 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012842
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012843 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012844
Dale Johannesenbd8e6502009-03-03 01:09:07 +000012845 CopyPrecedingStopPoint(I, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000012846 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012847 ++NumSunkInst;
12848 return true;
12849}
12850
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012851
12852/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
12853/// all reachable code to the worklist.
12854///
12855/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
12856/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
12857/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
12858/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
12859/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
12860///
12861static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012862 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012863 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012864 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000012865 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012866 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012867
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012868 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12869 BB = Worklist.back();
12870 Worklist.pop_back();
12871
12872 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
12873 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012874
12875 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Prev = NULL;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012876 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
12877 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012878
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012879 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
12880 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
12881 ++NumDeadInst;
12882 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
12883 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12884 continue;
12885 }
12886
12887 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012888 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, BB->getContext(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012889 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
12890 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
12891 ++NumConstProp;
12892 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12893 continue;
12894 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000012895
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012896 // If there are two consecutive llvm.dbg.stoppoint calls then
12897 // it is likely that the optimizer deleted code in between these
12898 // two intrinsics.
12899 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Next = dyn_cast<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(Inst);
12900 if (DBI_Next) {
12901 if (DBI_Prev
12902 && DBI_Prev->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint
12903 && DBI_Next->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint) {
12904 IC.RemoveFromWorkList(DBI_Prev);
12905 DBI_Prev->eraseFromParent();
12906 }
12907 DBI_Prev = DBI_Next;
Zhou Sheng8313ef42009-02-23 10:14:11 +000012908 } else {
12909 DBI_Prev = 0;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012910 }
12911
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012912 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012913 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012914
12915 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
12916 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
12917 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
12918 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12919 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12920 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012921 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012922 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012923 continue;
12924 }
12925 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12926 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12927 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12928 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12929 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012930 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012931 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012932 continue;
12933 }
12934
12935 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12936 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12937 continue;
12938 }
12939 }
12940
12941 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12942 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012943 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012944}
12945
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012946bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012947 bool Changed = false;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000012948 TD = &getAnalysis<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012949
12950 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12951 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012952
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012953 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012954 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12955 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12956 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012957 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012958 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012959
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012960 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12961 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12962 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12963 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12964 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12965 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12966 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12967 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012968
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012969 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012970 // A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
12971 // going to do one without it.
12972 if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
12973 ++NumDeadInst;
12974 Changed = true;
12975 }
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012976 if (!I->use_empty())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012977 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(I->getType()));
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012978 I->eraseFromParent();
12979 }
12980 }
12981 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012982
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012983 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12984 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12985 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012986
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012987 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012988 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012989 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012990 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012991 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012992 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012993
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012994 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012995
12996 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012997 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012998 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012999 continue;
13000 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000013001
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000013002 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000013003 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, F.getContext(), TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000013004 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000013005
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000013006 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000013007 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000013008 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
13009
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000013010 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000013011 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013012 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000013013 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013014 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000013015 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013016
Eli Friedmanfd2934f2009-07-15 22:13:34 +000013017 if (TD) {
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000013018 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000013019 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
13020 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i))
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000013021 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE,
13022 F.getContext(), TD))
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000013023 if (NewC != CE) {
13024 i->set(NewC);
13025 Changed = true;
13026 }
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000013027 }
13028
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013029 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000013030 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013031 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
13032 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
13033 if (UserParent != BB) {
13034 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
13035 // See if the user is one of our successors.
13036 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
13037 if (*SI == UserParent) {
13038 UserIsSuccessor = true;
13039 break;
13040 }
13041
13042 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
13043 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
13044 // otherwise), we can keep going.
13045 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
13046 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
13047 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
13048 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
13049 }
13050 }
13051
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013052 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000013053#ifndef NDEBUG
13054 std::string OrigI;
13055#endif
13056 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013057 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000013058 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013059 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000013060 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000013061 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
13062 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000013063
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013064 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
13065 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
13066
13067 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013068 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013069 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013070
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000013071 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
13072 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013073
13074 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
13075 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000013076 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
13077
13078 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
13079 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
13080 ++InsertPos;
13081
13082 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013083
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013084 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
13085 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013086 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000013087
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013088 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
13089 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013090 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013091
13092 // Erase the old instruction.
13093 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000013094 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000013095#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000013096 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
13097 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000013098#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000013099
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013100 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
13101 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013102 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
13103 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
13104 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013105 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000013106
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013107 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013108 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013109 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000013110 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013111 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013112 AddToWorkList(I);
13113 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013114 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000013115 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013116 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013117 }
13118 }
13119
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013120 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000013121
13122 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
13123 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013124 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000013125}
13126
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013127
13128bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000013129 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
13130
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013131 bool EverMadeChange = false;
13132
13133 // Iterate while there is work to do.
13134 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000013135 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013136 EverMadeChange = true;
13137 return EverMadeChange;
13138}
13139
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000013140FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013141 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000013142}